054bb1b13da485a5ca89cacdc4fd2a51e68d1101
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "common/format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
72 #include "mi/mi-main.h"
73
74 /* readline include files */
75 #include "readline/readline.h"
76 #include "readline/history.h"
77
78 /* readline defines this. */
79 #undef savestring
80
81 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
82 #include "extension.h"
83 #include <algorithm>
84 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
85 #include "common/array-view.h"
86 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
87
88 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
89 enum exception_event_kind
90 {
91 EX_EVENT_THROW,
92 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
93 EX_EVENT_CATCH
94 };
95
96 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
97
98 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
99 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
100
101 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
102
103 static void
104 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
105 struct linespec_result *canonical,
106 enum bptype type_wanted);
107
108 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
109 struct linespec_result *,
110 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
111 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
112 enum bptype,
113 enum bpdisp, int, int,
114 int,
115 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
116 int, int, int, unsigned);
117
118 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
119 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
120 struct program_space *search_pspace);
121
122 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
123 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
124
125 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
126
127 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
128 enum bptype,
129 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
130 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
131 const struct symtab_and_line *);
132
133 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
134 static. */
135 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
136 struct symtab_and_line,
137 enum bptype,
138 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
139
140 static struct breakpoint *
141 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
142 enum bptype type,
143 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
144 int loc_enabled);
145
146 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
147
148 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
149 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
150 enum bptype bptype);
151
152 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
153 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
154 struct obj_section *, int);
155
156 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
157 struct bp_location *loc2);
158
159 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
160 const struct address_space *aspace,
161 CORE_ADDR addr);
162
163 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
164 const address_space *,
165 CORE_ADDR, int);
166
167 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
168 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
169
170 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
171
172 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
173
174 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
175
176 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
177 enum bptype type,
178 int *other_type_used);
179
180 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
181 int count);
182
183 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
184 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
185 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
186
187 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
188
189 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
190 insert locations now. */
191 enum ugll_insert_mode
192 {
193 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
194 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
195 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
196 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
197 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
198 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
199 returns true on them.
200
201 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
202 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
203 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
204 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
205 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
206 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
207 the inferior. */
208 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
209
210 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
211 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
212 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
213
214 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
215 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
216 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
217 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
218 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
219 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
220 as no thread is running yet. */
221 UGLL_INSERT
222 };
223
224 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
225
226 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
227
228 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
229
230 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
231
232 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
233
234 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
235
236 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
237
238 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
239
240 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
241 otherwise. */
242
243 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
244
245 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
246 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
247 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
248 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
249
250 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
251 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
252
253 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
254 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
255
256 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
257 breakpoints. */
258 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
259
260 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
261 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
262
263 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
264 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
265
266 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
267 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
268 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
269 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
270 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
271 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
272
273 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
274 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
275 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
276 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
277 dprintf_style_gdb,
278 dprintf_style_call,
279 dprintf_style_agent,
280 NULL
281 };
282 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
283
284 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
285 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
286 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
287 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
288
289 static char *dprintf_function;
290
291 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
292 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
293 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
294 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
295 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
296 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
297 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
298
299 static char *dprintf_channel;
300
301 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
302 has disconnected. */
303 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
304
305 struct command_line *
306 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
307 {
308 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
309 }
310
311 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
312 current breakpoint. */
313
314 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
315
316 const char *
317 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
318 {
319 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
320 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
321 a breakpoint. */
322 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
323
324 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
325 }
326
327 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
328 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
329 if such is available. */
330 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
331
332 static void
333 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
334 struct cmd_list_element *c,
335 const char *value)
336 {
337 fprintf_filtered (file,
338 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
339 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
340 value);
341 }
342
343 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
344 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
345 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
346 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
347 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
348 static void
349 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
350 struct cmd_list_element *c,
351 const char *value)
352 {
353 fprintf_filtered (file,
354 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
355 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
356 value);
357 }
358
359 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
360 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
361 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
362 use hardware breakpoints. */
363 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
364 static void
365 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
366 struct cmd_list_element *c,
367 const char *value)
368 {
369 fprintf_filtered (file,
370 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
371 value);
372 }
373
374 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
375 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
376 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
377 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
378 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
379 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
380 processing user input. */
381 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
382
383 static void
384 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
385 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
386 {
387 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
388 value);
389 }
390
391 /* See breakpoint.h. */
392
393 int
394 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
395 {
396 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
397 {
398 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
399 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
400 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
401 return 1;
402 }
403 else if (target_has_execution)
404 {
405 if (always_inserted_mode)
406 {
407 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
408 are stopped. */
409 return 1;
410 }
411
412 if (threads_are_executing ())
413 return 1;
414
415 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
416 stopped, we still have events to process. */
417 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
418 if (tp->resumed
419 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
420 return 1;
421 }
422 return 0;
423 }
424
425 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
426
427 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
428 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
430 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
431 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
432 condition_evaluation_auto,
433 condition_evaluation_host,
434 condition_evaluation_target,
435 NULL
436 };
437
438 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
439 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
440
441 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
442 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
443 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
444
445 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
446 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
447 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
448 evaluation mode. */
449
450 static const char *
451 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
452 {
453 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
454 {
455 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
456 return condition_evaluation_target;
457 else
458 return condition_evaluation_host;
459 }
460 else
461 return mode;
462 }
463
464 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
465
466 static const char *
467 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
468 {
469 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
470 }
471
472 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
473 otherwise. */
474
475 static int
476 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
477 {
478 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
479
480 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
481 }
482
483 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
484 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
485
486 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
487 static int overlay_events_enabled;
488
489 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
490 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
491
492 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
494 current breakpoint. */
495
496 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
497
498 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
499 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
500 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
501 B = TMP)
502
503 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
504 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
505 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
506
507 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
508 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
509 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
510 BP_TMP++)
511
512 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
513 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
514 to where the loop should start from.
515 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
516 appropriate location to start with. */
517
518 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
519 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
520 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
521 BP_LOCP_START \
522 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
523 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
524 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
525
526 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
527
528 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
529 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
530 if (is_tracepoint (B))
531
532 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
533
534 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
535
536 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
537
538 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
539
540 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
541
542 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
543
544 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
545 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
546 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
547 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
548 an address you need to read. */
549
550 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
551
552 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
553 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
554 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
555 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
556 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
557
558 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
559
560 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
561 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
562 reported by a target. */
563 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
564
565 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
566
567 static int breakpoint_count;
568
569 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
570 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
571 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
572 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
573 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
574
575 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
576
577 static int tracepoint_count;
578
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
580 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
581 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
582
583 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
584
585 struct breakpoint *
586 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
587 void *user_data)
588 {
589 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
590
591 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
592 {
593 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
594 break;
595 }
596
597 return b;
598 }
599
600 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
601 static int
602 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
603 {
604 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
605 }
606
607 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
608
609 static void
610 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
611 {
612 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
613 breakpoint_count = num;
614 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
615 }
616
617 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
618 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
619 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
620
621 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
622 breakpoint made. */
623
624 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
625 {
626 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
627 }
628
629 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
630 breakpoint made. */
631
632 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
633 {
634 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
635 }
636
637 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
638
639 void
640 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
641 {
642 struct breakpoint *b;
643
644 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
645 b->hit_count = 0;
646 }
647
648 \f
649 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
650 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
651
652 struct breakpoint *
653 get_breakpoint (int num)
654 {
655 struct breakpoint *b;
656
657 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
658 if (b->number == num)
659 return b;
660
661 return NULL;
662 }
663
664 \f
665
666 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
667 evaluating conditions on its side. */
668
669 static void
670 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
671 {
672 struct bp_location *loc;
673
674 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
675 evaluating conditions and if the user has
676 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
677 side. */
678 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
679 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
680 return;
681
682 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
683 return;
684
685 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
686 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
687 }
688
689 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
690 evaluating conditions on its side. */
691
692 static void
693 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
694 {
695 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
696 evaluating conditions and if the user has
697 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
698 side. */
699 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
700 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
701
702 return;
703
704 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
705 return;
706
707 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
708 }
709
710 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
711 condition_evaluation_mode. */
712
713 static void
714 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
715 struct cmd_list_element *c)
716 {
717 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
718
719 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
720 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
721 {
722 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
723 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
724 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
725 return;
726 }
727
728 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
729 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
730
731 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
732 settings was "auto". */
733 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
734
735 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
736 if (new_mode != old_mode)
737 {
738 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
739 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
740 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
741
742 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
743 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
744 */
745
746 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
747 {
748 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
749 target. */
750 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
751 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
752 }
753 else
754 {
755 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
756 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
757 target knows about. */
758 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
759 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
760 loc->needs_update = 1;
761 }
762
763 /* Do the update. */
764 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
765 }
766
767 return;
768 }
769
770 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
771 what "auto" is translating to. */
772
773 static void
774 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
775 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
776 {
777 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
778 fprintf_filtered (file,
779 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
780 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
781 value,
782 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
783 else
784 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
785 value);
786 }
787
788 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
789 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
790 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
791
792 static int
793 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
794 {
795 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
796 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
797
798 if (a->address == b->address)
799 return 0;
800 else
801 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
802 }
803
804 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
805 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
806 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
807 return NULL. */
808
809 static struct bp_location **
810 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
811 {
812 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
814 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
815
816 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
817 dummy_loc.address = address;
818
819 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
820 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
821 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
822 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
823 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
824
825 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
826 if (locp_found == NULL)
827 return NULL;
828
829 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
830 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
831 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
832 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
833 locp_found--;
834
835 return locp_found;
836 }
837
838 void
839 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
840 int from_tty)
841 {
842 xfree (b->cond_string);
843 b->cond_string = NULL;
844
845 if (is_watchpoint (b))
846 {
847 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
848
849 w->cond_exp.reset ();
850 }
851 else
852 {
853 struct bp_location *loc;
854
855 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
856 {
857 loc->cond.reset ();
858
859 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
860 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
861 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
862 }
863 }
864
865 if (*exp == 0)
866 {
867 if (from_tty)
868 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
869 }
870 else
871 {
872 const char *arg = exp;
873
874 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
875 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
876 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
877 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
878
879 if (is_watchpoint (b))
880 {
881 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
882
883 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
884 arg = exp;
885 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
886 if (*arg)
887 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
888 w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
889 }
890 else
891 {
892 struct bp_location *loc;
893
894 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
895 {
896 arg = exp;
897 loc->cond =
898 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
899 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
900 if (*arg)
901 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
902 }
903 }
904 }
905 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
906
907 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
908 }
909
910 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
911
912 static void
913 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
914 completion_tracker &tracker,
915 const char *text, const char *word)
916 {
917 const char *space;
918
919 text = skip_spaces (text);
920 space = skip_to_space (text);
921 if (*space == '\0')
922 {
923 int len;
924 struct breakpoint *b;
925
926 if (text[0] == '$')
927 {
928 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
929 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
930 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
931 return;
932 }
933
934 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
935 len = strlen (text);
936
937 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
938 {
939 char number[50];
940
941 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
942
943 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
944 {
945 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
946 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
947 }
948 }
949
950 return;
951 }
952
953 /* We're completing the expression part. */
954 text = skip_spaces (space);
955 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
956 }
957
958 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
959
960 static void
961 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
962 {
963 struct breakpoint *b;
964 const char *p;
965 int bnum;
966
967 if (arg == 0)
968 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
969
970 p = arg;
971 bnum = get_number (&p);
972 if (bnum == 0)
973 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
974
975 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
976 if (b->number == bnum)
977 {
978 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
979 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
980 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
981 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
982 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
983
984 if (extlang != NULL)
985 {
986 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
987 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
988 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
989 }
990 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
991
992 if (is_breakpoint (b))
993 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
994
995 return;
996 }
997
998 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
999 }
1000
1001 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1002 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1003 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1004
1005 static void
1006 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1007 {
1008 struct command_line *c;
1009
1010 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1011 {
1012 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1013 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1014 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1015
1016 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1017 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1018
1019 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1020 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1021 command directly. */
1022 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1023 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1024
1025 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1026 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1027 }
1028 }
1029
1030 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1031 {
1032 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1033 };
1034
1035 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1036
1037 static bool
1038 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1039 {
1040 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1041 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1042 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1043 }
1044
1045 static bool
1046 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1047 {
1048 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1049 }
1050
1051 int
1052 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1053 {
1054 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1058 TYPE. */
1059
1060 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1061 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1062 {
1063 breakpoint *b;
1064
1065 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1066 b = new tracepoint ();
1067 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1068 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1069 else
1070 b = new breakpoint ();
1071
1072 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1073 }
1074
1075 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1076 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1077 found. */
1078
1079 static void
1080 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1081 struct command_line *commands)
1082 {
1083 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1084 {
1085 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1086 struct command_line *c;
1087 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1088
1089 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1090 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1091 ones might not. */
1092 t->step_count = 0;
1093
1094 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1095 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1096 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1097 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1098 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1099 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1100 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1101 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1102 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1103 tracepoint's context. */
1104 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1105 {
1106 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1107 {
1108 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1109 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1110 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1111 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1112 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1113 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1114
1115 if (while_stepping)
1116 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1117 "can be used only once"));
1118 else
1119 while_stepping = c;
1120 }
1121
1122 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1123 }
1124 if (while_stepping)
1125 {
1126 struct command_line *c2;
1127
1128 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1129 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1130 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1131 {
1132 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1133 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1134 }
1135 }
1136 }
1137 else
1138 {
1139 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1140 }
1141 }
1142
1143 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1144 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1145
1146 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1147 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1148 {
1149 struct breakpoint *b;
1150 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1151 struct bp_location *loc;
1152
1153 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1154 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1155 {
1156 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1157 if (loc->address == addr)
1158 found.push_back (b);
1159 }
1160
1161 return found;
1162 }
1163
1164 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1165 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1166
1167 void
1168 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1169 counted_command_line &&commands)
1170 {
1171 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1172
1173 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1174 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1175 }
1176
1177 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1178 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1179 commands. */
1180
1181 void
1182 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1183 {
1184 int old_silent = b->silent;
1185
1186 b->silent = silent;
1187 if (old_silent != silent)
1188 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1189 }
1190
1191 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1192 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1193
1194 void
1195 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1196 {
1197 int old_thread = b->thread;
1198
1199 b->thread = thread;
1200 if (old_thread != thread)
1201 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1202 }
1203
1204 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1205 breakpoint work for any task. */
1206
1207 void
1208 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1209 {
1210 int old_task = b->task;
1211
1212 b->task = task;
1213 if (old_task != task)
1214 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1215 }
1216
1217 static void
1218 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1219 struct command_line *control)
1220 {
1221 counted_command_line cmd;
1222 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1223 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1224 list of command by just typing "end". */
1225 bool cmd_read = false;
1226
1227 std::string new_arg;
1228
1229 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1230 {
1231 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1232 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1233 breakpoint_count);
1234 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1235 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1236 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1237 }
1238
1239 map_breakpoint_numbers
1240 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1241 {
1242 if (!cmd_read)
1243 {
1244 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1245 if (control != NULL)
1246 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1247 else
1248 {
1249 std::string str
1250 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1251 "%s, one per line."),
1252 arg);
1253
1254 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1255 {
1256 validate_actionline (line, b);
1257 };
1258 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1259 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1260 validator = do_validate;
1261
1262 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1263 }
1264 cmd_read = true;
1265 }
1266
1267 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1268 do anything. */
1269 if (b->commands != cmd)
1270 {
1271 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1272 b->commands = cmd;
1273 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1274 }
1275 });
1276 }
1277
1278 static void
1279 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1280 {
1281 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1285 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1286
1287 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1288 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1289 enum command_control_type
1290 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1291 {
1292 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1293 return simple_control;
1294 }
1295
1296 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1297
1298 static int
1299 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1300 {
1301 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1302 return 0;
1303 if (!bl->inserted)
1304 return 0;
1305 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1306 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1307 return 0;
1308 return 1;
1309 }
1310
1311 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1312 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1313 contents.
1314
1315 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1316 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1317 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1318
1319 static void
1320 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1321 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1322 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1323 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1324 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1325 {
1326 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1327 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1328 int bp_size = 0;
1329 int bptoffset = 0;
1330
1331 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1332 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1333 {
1334 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1335 return;
1336 }
1337
1338 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1339 we need to copy. */
1340 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1341 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1342
1343 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1344 {
1345 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1346 reading. */
1347 return;
1348 }
1349
1350 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1351 {
1352 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1353 reading. */
1354 return;
1355 }
1356
1357 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1358 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1359 {
1360 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1361 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1362 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1363 bp_addr = memaddr;
1364 }
1365
1366 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1367 {
1368 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1369 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1370 }
1371
1372 if (readbuf != NULL)
1373 {
1374 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1375 shadow_contents buffer. */
1376 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1377 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1378 + target_info->shadow_len));
1379
1380 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1381 shadow. */
1382 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1383 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1384 }
1385 else
1386 {
1387 const unsigned char *bp;
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1389 int placed_size;
1390
1391 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1392 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1393 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1394
1395 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1396 address. */
1397 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1398
1399 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1400 breakpoint's INSN. */
1401 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1402 }
1403 }
1404
1405 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1406 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1407
1408 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1409 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1410 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1411
1412 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1413 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1414 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1415 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1416 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1417 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1418 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1419 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1420 and:
1421 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1422
1423 void
1424 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1425 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1426 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1427 {
1428 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1429 search. */
1430 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1431
1432 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1433 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1434 report higher one. */
1435
1436 bc_l = 0;
1437 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1438 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1439 {
1440 struct bp_location *bl;
1441
1442 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1443 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1444
1445 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1446 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1447 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1448 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1449
1450 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1451 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1452 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1453
1454 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1455 >= bl->address)
1456 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1457 <= memaddr))
1458 bc_l = bc;
1459 else
1460 bc_r = bc;
1461 }
1462
1463 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1464 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1465 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1466 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1467 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1468 B:
1469
1470 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1471
1472 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1473 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1474 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1475 and L2. */
1476 while (bc_l > 0
1477 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1478 bc_l--;
1479
1480 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1481
1482 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1483 {
1484 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1485
1486 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1487 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1488 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1489 bl->owner->number);
1490
1491 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1492 content. */
1493
1494 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1495 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1496 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1497 break;
1498
1499 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1500 continue;
1501
1502 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1503 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1504 }
1505 }
1506
1507 \f
1508
1509 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1510 breakpoint. */
1511
1512 int
1513 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1514 {
1515 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1516 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1517 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1518 }
1519
1520 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1521
1522 static int
1523 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1524 {
1525 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1526 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1527 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1528 }
1529
1530 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1531 software. */
1532
1533 int
1534 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1535 {
1536 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1537 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1538 }
1539
1540 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1541 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1542 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1543 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1544 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1545 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1546 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1547 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1548
1549 static int
1550 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1551 {
1552 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1553 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1554 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1555 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1556 }
1557
1558 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1559 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1560
1561 static void
1562 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1563 {
1564 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1565 {
1566 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1567 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1568 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1569 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1570 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1571 }
1572 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1573 }
1574
1575 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1576 watchpoint W. */
1577
1578 static struct value *
1579 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1580 {
1581 struct value *bit_val;
1582
1583 if (val == NULL)
1584 return NULL;
1585
1586 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1587
1588 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1589 w->val_bitpos,
1590 w->val_bitsize,
1591 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1592 value_offset (val),
1593 val);
1594
1595 return bit_val;
1596 }
1597
1598 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1599 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1600 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1601 to be able to report stops. */
1602
1603 static void
1604 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1605 struct program_space *pspace)
1606 {
1607 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1608
1609 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1610 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1611 b->loc->address = -1;
1612 b->loc->length = -1;
1613 }
1614
1615 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1616 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1617
1618 static int
1619 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1620 {
1621 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1622 && b->loc != NULL
1623 && b->loc->next == NULL
1624 && b->loc->address == -1
1625 && b->loc->length == -1);
1626 }
1627
1628 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1629 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1630 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1631 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1632 in b->loc->cond.
1633 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1634
1635 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1636 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1637 it.
1638
1639 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1640 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1641 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1642 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1643 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1644 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1645 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1646 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1647
1648 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1649 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1650 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1651 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1652 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1653 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1654 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1655 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1656 not changed.
1657
1658 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1659 hardware watchpoints:
1660
1661 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1662 called several times when GDB stops.
1663
1664 [linux]
1665 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1666 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1667 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1668 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1669 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1670 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1671 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1672 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1673 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1674 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1675 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1676
1677 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1678 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1679
1680 static void
1681 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1682 {
1683 int within_current_scope;
1684 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1685 int frame_saved;
1686
1687 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1688 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1689 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1690 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1691 return;
1692
1693 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1694 return;
1695
1696 frame_saved = 0;
1697
1698 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1699 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1700 within_current_scope = 1;
1701 else
1702 {
1703 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1704 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1705 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1706
1707 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1708 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1709 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1710 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1711 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1712 return;
1713
1714 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1715 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1716 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1717 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1718 selected frame. */
1719 frame_saved = 1;
1720 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1721
1722 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1723 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1724 if (within_current_scope)
1725 select_frame (fi);
1726 }
1727
1728 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1729 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1730 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1731 b->loc = NULL;
1732
1733 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1734 {
1735 const char *s;
1736
1737 b->exp.reset ();
1738 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1739 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1740 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1741 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1742 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1743 be completely different objects. */
1744 b->val = NULL;
1745 b->val_valid = 0;
1746
1747 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1748 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1749 locations (re)created below. */
1750 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1751 {
1752 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1753
1754 s = b->cond_string;
1755 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1756 }
1757 }
1758
1759 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1760 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1761 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1762 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1763 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1764 if (!target_has_execution)
1765 {
1766 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1767 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1768 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1769 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1770 {
1771 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1772 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1773 else
1774 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1775 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1776 }
1777 }
1778 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1779 {
1780 int pc = 0;
1781 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1782 struct value *v, *result;
1783 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1784
1785 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1786
1787 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1788 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1789 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1790 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1791 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1792 watchpoints. */
1793 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1794 {
1795 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1796 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1797 b->val = release_value (v);
1798 b->val_valid = 1;
1799 }
1800
1801 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1802
1803 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1804 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1805 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1806 {
1807 v = iter.get ();
1808
1809 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1810 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1811 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1812 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1813 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1814 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1815 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1816 {
1817 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1818
1819 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1820 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1821 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1822 if (v == result
1823 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1824 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1825 {
1826 CORE_ADDR addr;
1827 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1828 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1829 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1830
1831 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1832 {
1833 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1834 sub-expression. */
1835 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1836 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1837 }
1838 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1839 {
1840 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1841 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1842 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1843 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1844 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1845 }
1846
1847 addr = value_address (v);
1848 if (bitsize != 0)
1849 {
1850 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1851 addr += bitpos / 8;
1852 }
1853
1854 type = hw_write;
1855 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1856 type = hw_read;
1857 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1858 type = hw_access;
1859
1860 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1861 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1862 ;
1863 *tmp = loc;
1864 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1865
1866 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1867 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1868
1869 if (bitsize != 0)
1870 {
1871 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1872 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1873 }
1874 else
1875 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1876
1877 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1878 }
1879 }
1880 }
1881
1882 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1883 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1884 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1885 is started. */
1886 if (reparse)
1887 {
1888 int reg_cnt;
1889 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1890 struct bp_location *bl;
1891
1892 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1893
1894 if (reg_cnt)
1895 {
1896 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1897 enum bptype type;
1898
1899 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1900 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1901 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1902
1903 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1904 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1905 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1906 this watchpoint in as well. */
1907
1908 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1909 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1910 hardware watchpoint type. */
1911 type = b->type;
1912 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1913 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1914
1915 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1916 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1917 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1918 through watch_command), so always account for it
1919 manually. */
1920
1921 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1922 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1923
1924 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1925 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1926
1927 target_resources_ok
1928 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1929 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1930 {
1931 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1932
1933 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1934 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1935 "hardware watchpoint."));
1936 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1937 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1938 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1939
1940 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1941 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1942 }
1943 else
1944 {
1945 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1946 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1947 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1948 nop. */
1949 b->type = type;
1950 }
1951 }
1952 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1953 {
1954 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1955 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1956 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1957 else
1958 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1959 "read/access watchpoint."));
1960 }
1961 else
1962 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1963
1964 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1965 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1966 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1967 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1968 }
1969
1970 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1971 above left it without any location set up. But,
1972 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1973 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1974 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1975 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1976 }
1977 else if (!within_current_scope)
1978 {
1979 printf_filtered (_("\
1980 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1981 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1982 b->number);
1983 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1984 }
1985
1986 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1987 if (frame_saved)
1988 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1989 }
1990
1991
1992 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1993 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1994 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1995 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1996 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1997 static int
1998 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1999 {
2000 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2001 return 0;
2002
2003 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2004 return 0;
2005
2006 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2007 return 0;
2008
2009 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2010 return 0;
2011
2012 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2013 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2014 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2015 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2016 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2017 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2018 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2019 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2020 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2021 return 0;
2022
2023 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2024 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2025 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2026 a breakpoint. */
2027 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2028 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2029 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2030 bl->address)
2031 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2032 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2033 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2034 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2035 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2036 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2037 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2038 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2039 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2040 {
2041 if (debug_infrun)
2042 {
2043 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2044 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2045 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2046 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2047 }
2048 return 0;
2049 }
2050
2051 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2052 instruction that triggered one. */
2053 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2054 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2055 {
2056 if (debug_infrun)
2057 {
2058 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2059 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2060 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2061 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2062 bl->length);
2063 }
2064 return 0;
2065 }
2066
2067 return 1;
2068 }
2069
2070 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2071 that the location is not duplicated. */
2072
2073 static int
2074 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2075 {
2076 int result;
2077 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2078
2079 bl->duplicate = 0;
2080 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2081 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2082 return result;
2083 }
2084
2085 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2086 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2087 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2088 any error during parsing. */
2089
2090 static agent_expr_up
2091 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2092 {
2093 if (cond == NULL)
2094 return NULL;
2095
2096 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2097
2098 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2099 that may show up. */
2100 try
2101 {
2102 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2103 }
2104
2105 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2106 {
2107 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2108 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2109 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2110 }
2111
2112 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2113 return aexpr;
2114 }
2115
2116 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2117 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2118 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2119 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2120 one of them is true. */
2121
2122 static void
2123 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2124 {
2125 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2126 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2127 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2128 struct bp_location *loc;
2129
2130 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2131 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2132
2133 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2134 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2135 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2136 side. */
2137 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2138 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2139 return;
2140
2141 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2142 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2143 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2144 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2145 response back to GDB. */
2146 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2147 {
2148 loc = (*loc2p);
2149 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2150 {
2151 if (modified)
2152 {
2153 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2154 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2155 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2156 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2157 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2158 loc->cond.get ());
2159 }
2160
2161 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2162 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2163 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2164 {
2165 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2166 break;
2167 }
2168 }
2169 }
2170
2171 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2172 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2173 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2174
2175 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2176 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2177 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2178 {
2179 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2180 {
2181 loc = (*loc2p);
2182 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2183 {
2184 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2185 located. */
2186 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2187 return;
2188
2189 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2190 }
2191 }
2192 }
2193
2194 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2195 for this location's address. */
2196 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2197 {
2198 loc = (*loc2p);
2199 if (loc->cond
2200 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2201 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2202 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2203 && loc->enabled)
2204 {
2205 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2206 to send the conditions to the target. */
2207 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2208 }
2209 }
2210
2211 return;
2212 }
2213
2214 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2215 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2216 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2217
2218 static agent_expr_up
2219 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2220 {
2221 const char *cmdrest;
2222 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2223 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2224
2225 if (cmd == NULL)
2226 return NULL;
2227
2228 cmdrest = cmd;
2229
2230 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2231 ++cmdrest;
2232 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2233
2234 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2235 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2236
2237 format_start = cmdrest;
2238
2239 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2240
2241 format_end = cmdrest;
2242
2243 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2244 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2245
2246 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2247
2248 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2249 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2250
2251 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2252 cmdrest++;
2253 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2254
2255 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2256
2257 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2258 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2259 {
2260 const char *cmd1;
2261
2262 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2263 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2264 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2265 cmdrest = cmd1;
2266 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2267 ++cmdrest;
2268 }
2269
2270 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2271
2272 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2273 that may show up. */
2274 try
2275 {
2276 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2277 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2278 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2279 }
2280 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2281 {
2282 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2283 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2284 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2285 }
2286
2287 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2288 return aexpr;
2289 }
2290
2291 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2292 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2293 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2294
2295 static void
2296 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2297 {
2298 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2299 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2300 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2301 struct bp_location *loc;
2302
2303 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2304 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2305
2306 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2307 return;
2308
2309 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2310 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2311 return;
2312
2313 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2314 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2315 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2316 control. */
2317 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2318 {
2319 loc = (*loc2p);
2320 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2321 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2322 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2323 return;
2324 }
2325
2326 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2327 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2328 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2329 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2330 response back to GDB. */
2331 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2332 {
2333 loc = (*loc2p);
2334 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2335 {
2336 if (modified)
2337 {
2338 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2339 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2340 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2341 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2342 loc->cmd_bytecode
2343 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2344 loc->owner->extra_string);
2345 }
2346
2347 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2348 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2349 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2350 {
2351 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2352 break;
2353 }
2354 }
2355 }
2356
2357 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2358 and so clean up. */
2359 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2360 {
2361 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2362 {
2363 loc = (*loc2p);
2364 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2365 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2366 {
2367 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2368 located. */
2369 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2370 return;
2371
2372 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2373 }
2374 }
2375 }
2376
2377 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2378 for this location's address. */
2379 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2380 {
2381 loc = (*loc2p);
2382 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2383 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2384 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2385 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2386 && loc->enabled)
2387 {
2388 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2389 to send the commands to the target. */
2390 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2391 }
2392 }
2393
2394 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2395 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2396 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2397 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2398 }
2399
2400 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2401 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2402 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2403 registers state. */
2404
2405 static int
2406 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2407 {
2408 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2409 {
2410 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2411 struct regcache *regcache;
2412
2413 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2414
2415 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2416 regcache, addr);
2417 }
2418 else
2419 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2420 }
2421
2422 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2423 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2424 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2425 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2426 -1 for failure.
2427
2428 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2429 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2430 static int
2431 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2432 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2433 int *disabled_breaks,
2434 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2435 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2436 {
2437 gdb_exception bp_excpt;
2438
2439 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2440 return 0;
2441
2442 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2443 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2444 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2445 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2446 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2447 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2448 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2449 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2450 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2451 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2452 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2453 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2454
2455 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2456 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2457 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2458 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2459
2460 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2461 {
2462 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2463 build_target_command_list (bl);
2464 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2465 bl->needs_update = 0;
2466 }
2467
2468 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2469 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2470 {
2471 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2472 {
2473 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2474 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2475 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2476
2477 Two important cases are:
2478 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2479 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2480 hardware breakpoint.
2481 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2482 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2483 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2484 so we undo.
2485
2486 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2487 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2488 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2489 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2490 gdb. */
2491 struct mem_region *mr
2492 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2493
2494 if (mr)
2495 {
2496 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2497 {
2498 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2499
2500 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2501 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2502 else
2503 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2504
2505 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2506 {
2507 static int said = 0;
2508
2509 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2510 if (!said)
2511 {
2512 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2513 _("Note: automatically using "
2514 "hardware breakpoints for "
2515 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2516 said = 1;
2517 }
2518 }
2519 }
2520 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2521 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2522 {
2523 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2524 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2525 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2526 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2527 bl->owner->number,
2528 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2529 return 1;
2530 }
2531 }
2532 }
2533
2534 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2535 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2536 || bl->section == NULL
2537 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2538 {
2539 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2540 try
2541 {
2542 int val;
2543
2544 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2545 if (val)
2546 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2547 }
2548 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2549 {
2550 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2551 }
2552 }
2553 else
2554 {
2555 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2556 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2557 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2558 {
2559 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2560 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2561 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2562 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2563 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2564 bl->owner->number);
2565 else
2566 {
2567 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2568 bl->section);
2569 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2570 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2571 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2572
2573 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2574 try
2575 {
2576 int val;
2577
2578 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2579 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2580 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2581 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2582 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2583 if (val)
2584 bp_excpt
2585 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2586 }
2587 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2588 {
2589 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2590 }
2591
2592 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2593 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2594 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2595 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2596 bl->owner->number);
2597 }
2598 }
2599 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2600 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2601 {
2602 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2603 try
2604 {
2605 int val;
2606
2607 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2608 if (val)
2609 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2610 }
2611 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2612 {
2613 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2614 }
2615 }
2616 else
2617 {
2618 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2619 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2620 return 0;
2621 }
2622 }
2623
2624 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2625 {
2626 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2627
2628 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2629 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2630 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2631 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2632 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2633 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2634 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2635 errors as memory errors. */
2636 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2637 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2638 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2639 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2640 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2641 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2642 bl->address)))
2643 {
2644 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2645 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2646 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2647 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2648 {
2649 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2650 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2651 bl->owner->number);
2652 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2653 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2654 "library breakpoints:\n");
2655 }
2656 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2657 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2658 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2659 return 0;
2660 }
2661 else
2662 {
2663 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2664 {
2665 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2666 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2667 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2668 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2669 bl->owner->number,
2670 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2671 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2672 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2673 bp_excpt.what ());
2674 }
2675 else
2676 {
2677 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2678 {
2679 std::string message
2680 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2681 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2682
2683 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2684 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2685 "%s\n",
2686 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2687 }
2688 else
2689 {
2690 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2691 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2692 bl->owner->number,
2693 bp_excpt.what ());
2694 }
2695 }
2696 return 1;
2697
2698 }
2699 }
2700 else
2701 bl->inserted = 1;
2702
2703 return 0;
2704 }
2705
2706 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2707 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2708 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2709 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2710 {
2711 int val;
2712
2713 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2714 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2715
2716 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2717
2718 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2719 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2720 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2721 {
2722 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2723
2724 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2725 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2726 of this one. */
2727 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2728 if (loc != bl
2729 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2730 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2731 {
2732 bl->duplicate = 1;
2733 bl->inserted = 1;
2734 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2735 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2736 val = 0;
2737 break;
2738 }
2739
2740 if (val == 1)
2741 {
2742 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2743 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2744
2745 if (val)
2746 /* Back to the original value. */
2747 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2748 }
2749 }
2750
2751 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2752 }
2753
2754 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2755 {
2756 int val;
2757
2758 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2759 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2760
2761 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2762 if (val)
2763 {
2764 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2765
2766 if (val == 1)
2767 warning (_("\
2768 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2769 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2770 else
2771 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2772 }
2773
2774 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2775
2776 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2777 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2778 so just return success. */
2779 return 0;
2780 }
2781
2782 return 0;
2783 }
2784
2785 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2786 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2787 PSPACE anymore. */
2788
2789 void
2790 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2791 {
2792 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2793 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2794
2795 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2796 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2797 {
2798 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2799 delete_breakpoint (b);
2800 }
2801
2802 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2803 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2804 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2805 {
2806 struct bp_location *tmp;
2807
2808 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2809 {
2810 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2811 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2812 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2813 else
2814 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2815 if (tmp->next == loc)
2816 {
2817 tmp->next = loc->next;
2818 break;
2819 }
2820 }
2821 }
2822
2823 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2824 removed locations above. */
2825 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2826 }
2827
2828 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2829 Throws exception on any error.
2830 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2831 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2832 void
2833 insert_breakpoints (void)
2834 {
2835 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2836
2837 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2838 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2839 {
2840 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2841
2842 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2843 }
2844
2845 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2846 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2847 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2848 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2849 }
2850
2851 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2852
2853 void
2854 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2855 {
2856 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2857
2858 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2859 {
2860 callback (loc, NULL);
2861 }
2862 }
2863
2864 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2865 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2866 always-inserted mode. */
2867
2868 static void
2869 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2870 {
2871 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2872 int error_flag = 0;
2873 int val = 0;
2874 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2875 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2876 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2877
2878 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2879
2880 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2881 there was an error. */
2882 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2883
2884 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2885
2886 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2887 {
2888 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2889 breakpoints. */
2890 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2891 continue;
2892
2893 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2894 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2895 deletion of breakpoints. */
2896 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2897 continue;
2898
2899 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2900
2901 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2902 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2903 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2904 insert breakpoints. */
2905 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2906 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2907 continue;
2908
2909 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2910 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2911 if (val)
2912 error_flag = val;
2913 }
2914
2915 if (error_flag)
2916 {
2917 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2918 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2919 }
2920 }
2921
2922 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2923
2924 static void
2925 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2926 {
2927 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2928 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2929 int error_flag = 0;
2930 int val = 0;
2931 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2932 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2933 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2934
2935 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2936
2937 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2938 there was an error. */
2939 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2940
2941 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2942
2943 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2944 {
2945 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2946 continue;
2947
2948 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2949 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2950 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2951 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2952 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2953 continue;
2954
2955 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2956
2957 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2958 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2959 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2960 insert breakpoints. */
2961 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2962 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2963 continue;
2964
2965 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2966 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2967 if (val)
2968 error_flag = val;
2969 }
2970
2971 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2972 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2974 {
2975 int some_failed = 0;
2976 struct bp_location *loc;
2977
2978 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2979 continue;
2980
2981 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2982 continue;
2983
2984 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2985 continue;
2986
2987 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2988 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2989 {
2990 some_failed = 1;
2991 break;
2992 }
2993 if (some_failed)
2994 {
2995 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2996 if (loc->inserted)
2997 remove_breakpoint (loc);
2998
2999 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3000 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3001 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3002 bpt->number);
3003 error_flag = -1;
3004 }
3005 }
3006
3007 if (error_flag)
3008 {
3009 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3010 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3011 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3012 {
3013 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3014 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3015 }
3016 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3017 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3018 }
3019 }
3020
3021 /* Used when the program stops.
3022 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3023 removing a breakpoint location. */
3024
3025 int
3026 remove_breakpoints (void)
3027 {
3028 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3029 int val = 0;
3030
3031 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3032 {
3033 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3034 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3035 }
3036 return val;
3037 }
3038
3039 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3040 that thread. */
3041
3042 static void
3043 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3044 {
3045 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3046
3047 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3048 {
3049 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3050 {
3051 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3052
3053 printf_filtered (_("\
3054 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3055 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3056
3057 /* Hide it from the user. */
3058 b->number = 0;
3059 }
3060 }
3061 }
3062
3063 /* Remove breakpoints of inferior INF. */
3064
3065 int
3066 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3067 {
3068 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3069 int val;
3070
3071 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3072 {
3073 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3074 continue;
3075
3076 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3077 {
3078 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3079 if (val != 0)
3080 return val;
3081 }
3082 }
3083 return 0;
3084 }
3085
3086 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3087
3088 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3089 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3090 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3091 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3092 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3093 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3094 static void
3095 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3096 {
3097 if (internal)
3098 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3099 else
3100 {
3101 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3102 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3103 }
3104 }
3105
3106 static struct breakpoint *
3107 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3108 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3109 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3110 {
3111 symtab_and_line sal;
3112 sal.pc = address;
3113 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3114 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3115
3116 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3117 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3118 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3119
3120 return b;
3121 }
3122
3123 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3124 {
3125 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3126 };
3127 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3128
3129 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3130 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3131 {
3132 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3133 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3134
3135 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3136 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3137
3138 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3139 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3140
3141 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3142 references. */
3143 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3144
3145 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3146 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3147
3148 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3149 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3150
3151 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3152 int exception_searched = 0;
3153
3154 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3155 references. */
3156 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3157 };
3158
3159 static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
3160 breakpoint_objfile_key;
3161
3162 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3163 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3164
3165 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3166
3167 static int
3168 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3169 {
3170 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3171 }
3172
3173 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3174 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3175
3176 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3177 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3178 {
3179 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3180
3181 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
3182 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3183 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
3184 return bp_objfile_data;
3185 }
3186
3187 static void
3188 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3189 {
3190 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3191
3192 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3193 {
3194 struct breakpoint *b;
3195 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3196 CORE_ADDR addr;
3197 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3198
3199 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3200
3201 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3202 continue;
3203
3204 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3205 {
3206 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3207
3208 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3209 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3210 {
3211 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3212 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3213 continue;
3214 }
3215 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3216 }
3217
3218 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3219 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3220 bp_overlay_event,
3221 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3222 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3223 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3224 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3225
3226 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3227 {
3228 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3229 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3230 }
3231 else
3232 {
3233 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3234 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3235 }
3236 }
3237 }
3238
3239 static void
3240 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3241 {
3242 struct program_space *pspace;
3243
3244 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3245
3246 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3247 {
3248 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3249
3250 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3251 {
3252 int i;
3253 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3254 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3255
3256 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3257
3258 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3259
3260 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3261 {
3262 std::vector<probe *> ret
3263 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3264
3265 if (!ret.empty ())
3266 {
3267 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3268 probe *p = ret[0];
3269
3270 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3271 {
3272 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3273 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3274 ret.clear ();
3275 }
3276 }
3277 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3278 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3279 }
3280
3281 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3282 {
3283 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3284 {
3285 struct breakpoint *b;
3286
3287 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3288 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3289 bp_longjmp_master,
3290 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3291 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3292 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3293 }
3294
3295 continue;
3296 }
3297
3298 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3299 continue;
3300
3301 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3302 {
3303 struct breakpoint *b;
3304 const char *func_name;
3305 CORE_ADDR addr;
3306 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3307
3308 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3309 continue;
3310
3311 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3312 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3313 {
3314 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3315
3316 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3317 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3318 {
3319 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3320 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3321 continue;
3322 }
3323 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3324 }
3325
3326 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3327 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3328 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3329 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3330 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3331 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3332 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3333 }
3334 }
3335 }
3336 }
3337
3338 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3339 static void
3340 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3341 {
3342 struct program_space *pspace;
3343 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3344
3345 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3346
3347 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3348 {
3349 CORE_ADDR addr;
3350
3351 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3352
3353 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3354 {
3355 struct breakpoint *b;
3356 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3357 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3358
3359 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3360
3361 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3362 continue;
3363
3364 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3365 {
3366 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3367
3368 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3369 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3370 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3371 {
3372 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3373 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3374 continue;
3375 }
3376 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3377 }
3378
3379 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3380 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3381 bp_std_terminate_master,
3382 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3383 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3384 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3385 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3386 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3387 }
3388 }
3389 }
3390
3391 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3392
3393 static void
3394 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3395 {
3396 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3397
3398 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3399 {
3400 struct breakpoint *b;
3401 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3402 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3403 CORE_ADDR addr;
3404 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3405
3406 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3407
3408 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3409 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3410 {
3411 std::vector<probe *> ret
3412 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3413
3414 if (!ret.empty ())
3415 {
3416 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3417 probe *p = ret[0];
3418
3419 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3420 {
3421 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3422 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3423 ret.clear ();
3424 }
3425 }
3426 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3427 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3428 }
3429
3430 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3431 {
3432 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3433
3434 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3435 {
3436 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3437 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3438 bp_exception_master,
3439 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3440 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3441 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3442 }
3443
3444 continue;
3445 }
3446
3447 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3448
3449 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3450 continue;
3451
3452 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3453
3454 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3455 {
3456 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3457
3458 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3459 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3460 {
3461 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3462 continue;
3463 }
3464
3465 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3466 }
3467
3468 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3469 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3470 current_top_target ());
3471 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3472 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3473 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3474 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3475 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3476 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3477 }
3478 }
3479
3480 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3481
3482 static int
3483 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3484 {
3485 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3486 }
3487
3488 void
3489 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3490 {
3491 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3492 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3493
3494 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3495 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3496 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3497 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3498 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3499 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3500 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3501 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3502 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3503 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3504 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3505
3506 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3507 {
3508 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3509 continue;
3510
3511 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3512 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3513 {
3514 delete_breakpoint (b);
3515 continue;
3516 }
3517
3518 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3519 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3520 {
3521 delete_breakpoint (b);
3522 continue;
3523 }
3524
3525 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3526 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3527 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3528 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3529 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3530 {
3531 delete_breakpoint (b);
3532 continue;
3533 }
3534
3535 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3536 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3537 {
3538 delete_breakpoint (b);
3539 continue;
3540 }
3541
3542 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3543 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3544 {
3545 delete_breakpoint (b);
3546 continue;
3547 }
3548
3549 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3550 after an exec. */
3551 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3552 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3553 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3554 {
3555 delete_breakpoint (b);
3556 continue;
3557 }
3558
3559 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3560 {
3561 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3562 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3563 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3564 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3565 continue;
3566 }
3567
3568 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3569 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3570 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3571 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3572 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3573 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3574
3575 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3576 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3577 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3578 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3579 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3580 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3581 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3582
3583 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3584 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3585 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3586 let finish_command delete it.
3587
3588 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3589 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3590 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3591 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3592 solib breakpoints.) */
3593
3594 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3595 {
3596 continue;
3597 }
3598
3599 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3600 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3601 a.out. */
3602 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3603 {
3604 delete_breakpoint (b);
3605 continue;
3606 }
3607 }
3608 }
3609
3610 int
3611 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3612 {
3613 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3614 int val = 0;
3615 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3616 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3617
3618 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3619 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3620
3621 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3622 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3623 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3624 {
3625 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3626 continue;
3627
3628 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3629 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3630 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3631 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3632 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3633 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3634 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3635 continue;
3636
3637 if (bl->inserted)
3638 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3639 }
3640
3641 return val;
3642 }
3643
3644 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3645 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3646 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3647 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3648 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3649
3650 static int
3651 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3652 {
3653 int val;
3654
3655 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3656 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3657
3658 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3659 This should not ever happen. */
3660 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3661
3662 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3663 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3664 {
3665 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3666 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3667 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3668
3669 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3670 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3671 || bl->section == NULL
3672 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3673 {
3674 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3675
3676 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3677 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3678 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3679 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3680 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3681 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3682 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3683 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3684 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3685 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3686 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3687 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3688 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3689 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3690 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3691 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3692 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3693 they should always be removed. */
3694 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3695 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3696 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3697 val = 0;
3698 else
3699 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3700 }
3701 else
3702 {
3703 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3704 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3705 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3706 {
3707 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3708 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3709 */
3710 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3711 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3712 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3713 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3714 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3715 else
3716 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3717 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3718 reason);
3719 }
3720 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3721 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3722 if (bl->inserted)
3723 {
3724 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3725 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3726 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3727 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3728
3729 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3730 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3731 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3732 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3733 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3734 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3735 else
3736 val = 0;
3737 }
3738 else
3739 {
3740 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3741 val = 0;
3742 }
3743 }
3744
3745 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3746 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3747 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3748 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3749 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3750 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3751 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3752 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3753 always-inserted mode. */
3754 if (val
3755 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3756 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3757 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3758 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3759 bl->address))))
3760 val = 0;
3761
3762 if (val)
3763 return val;
3764 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3765 }
3766 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3767 {
3768 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3769 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3770
3771 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3772 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3773
3774 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3775 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3776 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3777 bl->owner->number);
3778 }
3779 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3780 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3781 && !bl->duplicate)
3782 {
3783 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3784 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3785
3786 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3787 if (val)
3788 return val;
3789
3790 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3791 }
3792
3793 return 0;
3794 }
3795
3796 static int
3797 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3798 {
3799 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3800 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3801
3802 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3803 This should not ever happen. */
3804 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3805
3806 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3807
3808 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3809
3810 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3811 }
3812
3813 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3814
3815 void
3816 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3817 {
3818 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3819
3820 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3821 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3822 bl->inserted = 0;
3823 }
3824
3825 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3826 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3827
3828 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3829 between runs.
3830
3831 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3832 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3833 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3834
3835
3836
3837 void
3838 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3839 {
3840 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3841 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3842
3843 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3844 nothing to do. */
3845 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3846 return;
3847
3848 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3849
3850 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3851 {
3852 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3853 continue;
3854
3855 switch (b->type)
3856 {
3857 case bp_call_dummy:
3858 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3859
3860 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3861 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3862 rid of it. */
3863
3864 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3865
3866 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3867
3868 case bp_shlib_event:
3869
3870 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3871 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3872 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3873 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3874 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3875
3876 (gdb) file prog-linux
3877 (gdb) run # native linux target
3878 ...
3879 (gdb) kill
3880 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3881 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3882 */
3883
3884 case bp_step_resume:
3885
3886 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3887
3888 case bp_single_step:
3889
3890 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3891
3892 delete_breakpoint (b);
3893 break;
3894
3895 case bp_watchpoint:
3896 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3897 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3898 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3899 {
3900 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3901
3902 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3903 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3904 delete_breakpoint (b);
3905 else
3906 {
3907 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3908 valid. New ones will be created in
3909 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3910 The next update_global_location_list call will
3911 garbage collect them. */
3912 b->loc = NULL;
3913
3914 if (context == inf_starting)
3915 {
3916 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3917 insert_breakpoints. */
3918 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3919 w->val_valid = 0;
3920 }
3921 }
3922 }
3923 break;
3924 default:
3925 break;
3926 }
3927 }
3928
3929 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3930 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
3931 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3932 moribund_locations.clear ();
3933 }
3934
3935 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3936 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3937 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3938 match, not program space. */
3939
3940 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3941 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3942 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3943 permanent breakpoint.
3944 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3945 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3946 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3947 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3948 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3949
3950 enum breakpoint_here
3951 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3952 {
3953 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3954 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3955
3956 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3957 {
3958 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3959 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3960 continue;
3961
3962 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3963 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3964 || bl->permanent)
3965 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3966 {
3967 if (overlay_debugging
3968 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3969 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3970 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3971 else if (bl->permanent)
3972 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3973 else
3974 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3975 }
3976 }
3977
3978 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
3979 }
3980
3981 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3982
3983 int
3984 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
3985 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
3986 {
3987 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3988
3989 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3990 {
3991 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3992 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3993 continue;
3994
3995 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3996 || bl->permanent)
3997 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
3998 addr, len))
3999 {
4000 if (overlay_debugging
4001 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4002 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4003 {
4004 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4005 continue;
4006 }
4007
4008 return 1;
4009 }
4010 }
4011
4012 return 0;
4013 }
4014
4015 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4016
4017 int
4018 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4019 {
4020 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4021 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4022 return 1;
4023
4024 return 0;
4025 }
4026
4027 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4028 ASPACE. */
4029
4030 static int
4031 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4032 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4033 {
4034 if (bl->inserted
4035 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4036 aspace, pc))
4037 {
4038 if (overlay_debugging
4039 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4040 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4041 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4042 else
4043 return 1;
4044 }
4045 return 0;
4046 }
4047
4048 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4049
4050 int
4051 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4052 {
4053 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4054
4055 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4056 {
4057 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4058
4059 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4060 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4061 continue;
4062
4063 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4064 return 1;
4065 }
4066 return 0;
4067 }
4068
4069 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4070 inserted at PC. */
4071
4072 int
4073 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4074 CORE_ADDR pc)
4075 {
4076 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4077
4078 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4079 {
4080 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4081
4082 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4083 continue;
4084
4085 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4086 return 1;
4087 }
4088
4089 return 0;
4090 }
4091
4092 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4093
4094 int
4095 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4096 CORE_ADDR pc)
4097 {
4098 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4099
4100 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4101 {
4102 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4103
4104 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4105 continue;
4106
4107 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4108 return 1;
4109 }
4110
4111 return 0;
4112 }
4113
4114 int
4115 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4116 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4117 {
4118 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4119
4120 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4121 {
4122 struct bp_location *loc;
4123
4124 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4125 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4126 continue;
4127
4128 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4129 continue;
4130
4131 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4132 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4133 {
4134 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4135
4136 /* Check for intersection. */
4137 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4138 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4139 if (l < h)
4140 return 1;
4141 }
4142 }
4143 return 0;
4144 }
4145 \f
4146
4147 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4148 in breakpoint.h. */
4149
4150 int
4151 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4152 {
4153 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4154 }
4155
4156 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4157 'next' chain. */
4158
4159 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4160 {
4161 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4162 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4163 }
4164
4165 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4166 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4167
4168 void
4169 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4170 {
4171 bpstat p;
4172 bpstat q;
4173
4174 if (bsp == 0)
4175 return;
4176 p = *bsp;
4177 while (p != NULL)
4178 {
4179 q = p->next;
4180 delete p;
4181 p = q;
4182 }
4183 *bsp = NULL;
4184 }
4185
4186 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4187 : next (NULL),
4188 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4189 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4190 commands (other.commands),
4191 print (other.print),
4192 stop (other.stop),
4193 print_it (other.print_it)
4194 {
4195 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4196 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4197 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4198 }
4199
4200 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4201 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4202
4203 bpstat
4204 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4205 {
4206 bpstat p = NULL;
4207 bpstat tmp;
4208 bpstat retval = NULL;
4209
4210 if (bs == NULL)
4211 return bs;
4212
4213 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4214 {
4215 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4216
4217 if (p == NULL)
4218 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4219 retval = tmp;
4220 else
4221 p->next = tmp;
4222 p = tmp;
4223 }
4224 p->next = NULL;
4225 return retval;
4226 }
4227
4228 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4229
4230 bpstat
4231 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4232 {
4233 if (bsp == NULL)
4234 return NULL;
4235
4236 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4237 {
4238 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4239 return bsp;
4240 }
4241 return NULL;
4242 }
4243
4244 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4245
4246 int
4247 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4248 {
4249 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4250 {
4251 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4252 {
4253 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4254 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4255 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4256 return 1;
4257 }
4258 else
4259 {
4260 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4261 sig))
4262 return 1;
4263 }
4264 }
4265
4266 return 0;
4267 }
4268
4269 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4270 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4271 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4272 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4273
4274 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4275 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4276 we set it.
4277 Return 1 otherwise. */
4278
4279 int
4280 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4281 {
4282 struct breakpoint *b;
4283
4284 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4285 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4286
4287 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4288 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4289 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4290 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4291 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4292 if (b == NULL)
4293 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4294
4295 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4296 return 1;
4297 }
4298
4299 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4300
4301 void
4302 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4303 {
4304 bpstat bs;
4305
4306 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4307 return;
4308
4309 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4310 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4311 {
4312 bs->commands = NULL;
4313 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4314 }
4315 }
4316
4317 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4318
4319 static void
4320 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4321 {
4322 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4323 {
4324 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4325
4326 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4327 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4328 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4329 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4330 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4331 return;
4332 }
4333
4334 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4335 }
4336
4337 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4338 or its equivalent. */
4339
4340 static int
4341 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4342 {
4343 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4344 }
4345
4346 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4347 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4348 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4349 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4350
4351 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4352 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4353 bpstat of the current thread. */
4354
4355 static int
4356 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4357 {
4358 bpstat bs;
4359 int again = 0;
4360
4361 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4362 in bs->commands. */
4363 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4364 return 0;
4365
4366 scoped_restore save_executing
4367 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4368
4369 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4370
4371 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4372 bs = *bsp;
4373
4374 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4375 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4376 {
4377 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4378
4379 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4380
4381 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4382 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4383 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4384 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4385 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4386 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4387 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4388 the tree when we're done. */
4389 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4390 bs->commands = NULL;
4391 if (ccmd != NULL)
4392 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4393 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4394 {
4395 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4396 cmd = cmd->next;
4397 }
4398
4399 while (cmd != NULL)
4400 {
4401 execute_control_command (cmd);
4402
4403 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4404 break;
4405 else
4406 cmd = cmd->next;
4407 }
4408
4409 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4410 {
4411 if (current_ui->async)
4412 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4413 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4414 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4415 ;
4416 else
4417 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4418 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4419 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4420 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4421 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4422 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4423 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4424 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4425 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4426 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4427 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4428 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4429 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4430 again = 1;
4431 break;
4432 }
4433 }
4434 return again;
4435 }
4436
4437 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4438 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4439
4440 static thread_info *
4441 get_bpstat_thread ()
4442 {
4443 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4444 return NULL;
4445
4446 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4447 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4448 return NULL;
4449 return tp;
4450 }
4451
4452 void
4453 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4454 {
4455 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4456 thread_info *tp;
4457
4458 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4459 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4460 {
4461 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4462 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4463 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4464 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4465 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4466 break;
4467 }
4468
4469 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4470 }
4471
4472 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4473
4474 static void
4475 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4476 {
4477 if (val == NULL)
4478 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4479 else
4480 {
4481 struct value_print_options opts;
4482 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4483 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4484 }
4485 }
4486
4487 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4488 debugging multiple threads. */
4489
4490 void
4491 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4492 {
4493 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4494 return;
4495
4496 uiout->text ("\n");
4497
4498 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4499 {
4500 const char *name;
4501 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4502
4503 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4504 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4505
4506 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4507 if (name != NULL)
4508 {
4509 uiout->text (" \"");
4510 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4511 uiout->text ("\"");
4512 }
4513
4514 uiout->text (" hit ");
4515 }
4516 }
4517
4518 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4519 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4520 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4521 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4522 normal_stop(). */
4523
4524 static enum print_stop_action
4525 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4526 {
4527 switch (bs->print_it)
4528 {
4529 case print_it_noop:
4530 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4531 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4532 break;
4533
4534 case print_it_done:
4535 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4536 relevant messages. */
4537 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4538 break;
4539
4540 case print_it_normal:
4541 {
4542 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4543
4544 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4545 which has since been deleted. */
4546 if (b == NULL)
4547 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4548
4549 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4550 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4551 }
4552 break;
4553
4554 default:
4555 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4556 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4557 break;
4558 }
4559 }
4560
4561 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4562
4563 static void
4564 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4565 {
4566 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4567 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4568
4569 if (!is_catchpoint)
4570 {
4571 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4572 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4573 else
4574 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4575 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4576 }
4577
4578 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4579 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4580 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4581
4582 if (any_deleted)
4583 {
4584 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4585 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4586 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4587 {
4588 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4589
4590 if (ix > 0)
4591 current_uiout->text (" ");
4592 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4593 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4594 }
4595 }
4596
4597 if (any_added)
4598 {
4599 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4600 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4601 bool first = true;
4602 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4603 {
4604 if (!first)
4605 current_uiout->text (" ");
4606 first = false;
4607 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4608 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4609 }
4610 }
4611 }
4612
4613 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4614 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4615 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4616 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4617 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4618 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4619 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4620 routine is one of:
4621
4622 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4623 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4624 code to print the location. An example is
4625 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4626 the location.
4627 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4628 to also print the location part of the message.
4629 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4630 don't require a location appended to the end.
4631 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4632 further info to be printed. */
4633
4634 enum print_stop_action
4635 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4636 {
4637 enum print_stop_action val;
4638
4639 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4640 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4641 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4642 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4643 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4644 {
4645 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4646 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4647 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4648 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4649 return val;
4650 }
4651
4652 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4653 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4654 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4655 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4656 {
4657 print_solib_event (0);
4658 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4659 }
4660
4661 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4662 with and nothing was printed. */
4663 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4664 }
4665
4666 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4667
4668 static bool
4669 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4670 {
4671 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4672 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4673
4674 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4675 return res;
4676 }
4677
4678 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4679
4680 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4681 : next (NULL),
4682 bp_location_at (bl),
4683 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4684 commands (NULL),
4685 print (0),
4686 stop (0),
4687 print_it (print_it_normal)
4688 {
4689 incref_bp_location (bl);
4690 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4691 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4692 }
4693
4694 bpstats::bpstats ()
4695 : next (NULL),
4696 bp_location_at (NULL),
4697 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4698 commands (NULL),
4699 print (0),
4700 stop (0),
4701 print_it (print_it_normal)
4702 {
4703 }
4704 \f
4705 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4706 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4707
4708 int
4709 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4710 {
4711 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4712 CORE_ADDR addr;
4713 struct breakpoint *b;
4714
4715 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4716 {
4717 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4718 as not triggered. */
4719 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4720 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4721 {
4722 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4723
4724 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4725 }
4726
4727 return 0;
4728 }
4729
4730 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4731 {
4732 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4733 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4734 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4735 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4736 {
4737 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4738
4739 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4740 }
4741
4742 return 1;
4743 }
4744
4745 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4746 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4747 triggered. */
4748
4749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4750 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4751 {
4752 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4753 struct bp_location *loc;
4754
4755 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4756 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4757 {
4758 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4759 {
4760 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4761 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4762
4763 if (newaddr == start)
4764 {
4765 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4766 break;
4767 }
4768 }
4769 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4770 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4771 addr, loc->address,
4772 loc->length))
4773 {
4774 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4775 break;
4776 }
4777 }
4778 }
4779
4780 return 1;
4781 }
4782
4783 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4784 enum wp_check_result
4785 {
4786 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4787 WP_DELETED = 1,
4788
4789 /* The value has changed. */
4790 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4791
4792 /* The value has not changed. */
4793 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4794
4795 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4796 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4797 };
4798
4799 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4800 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4801
4802 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4803 changed. */
4804
4805 static wp_check_result
4806 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4807 {
4808 struct watchpoint *b;
4809 struct frame_info *fr;
4810 int within_current_scope;
4811
4812 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4813 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4814 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4815
4816 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4817 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4818 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4819 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4820 return WP_IGNORE;
4821
4822 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4823 within_current_scope = 1;
4824 else
4825 {
4826 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4827 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4828 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4829
4830 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4831 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4832 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4833 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4834 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4835 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4836 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4837 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4838 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4839 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4840 return WP_IGNORE;
4841
4842 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4843 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4844
4845 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4846 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4847 if (within_current_scope)
4848 {
4849 struct symbol *function;
4850
4851 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4852 if (function == NULL
4853 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4854 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4855 within_current_scope = 0;
4856 }
4857
4858 if (within_current_scope)
4859 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4860 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4861 the user. */
4862 select_frame (fr);
4863 }
4864
4865 if (within_current_scope)
4866 {
4867 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4868 time before we return to the command level and call
4869 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4870 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4871
4872 int pc = 0;
4873 struct value *mark;
4874 struct value *new_val;
4875
4876 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4877 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4878 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4879 a mask watchpoint. */
4880 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4881
4882 mark = value_mark ();
4883 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4884
4885 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4886 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4887
4888 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4889 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4890 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4891 not what we want. */
4892 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4893 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4894 new_val)))
4895 {
4896 bs->old_val = b->val;
4897 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4898 b->val_valid = 1;
4899 if (new_val != NULL)
4900 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4901 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4902 }
4903 else
4904 {
4905 /* Nothing changed. */
4906 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4907 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4908 }
4909 }
4910 else
4911 {
4912 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4913 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4914 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4915 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4916 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4917 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4918 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4919 the first value assigned). */
4920 /* We print all the stop information in
4921 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4922 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4923 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4924 here. */
4925
4926 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4927 {
4928 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4929
4930 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4931 uiout->field_string
4932 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4933 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4934 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4935 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4936 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4937 }
4938
4939 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4940 b->commands = NULL;
4941 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4942
4943 return WP_DELETED;
4944 }
4945 }
4946
4947 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4948 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4949 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4950
4951 static int
4952 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4953 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4954 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4955 {
4956 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4957
4958 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4959 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4960
4961 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4962 }
4963
4964 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4965 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4966
4967 static void
4968 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4969 {
4970 const struct bp_location *bl;
4971 struct watchpoint *b;
4972
4973 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
4974 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
4975 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
4976 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4977 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4978
4979 {
4980 int must_check_value = 0;
4981
4982 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
4983 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
4984 watched value. */
4985 must_check_value = 1;
4986 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
4987 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
4988 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
4989 this watchpoint. */
4990 must_check_value = 1;
4991 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
4992 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
4993 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
4994 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
4995 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
4996 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
4997 must_check_value = 1;
4998
4999 if (must_check_value)
5000 {
5001 wp_check_result e;
5002
5003 try
5004 {
5005 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5006 }
5007 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5008 {
5009 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5010 "Error evaluating expression "
5011 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5012 b->number);
5013
5014 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5015 {
5016 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5017 b->number);
5018 }
5019 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5020 e = WP_DELETED;
5021 }
5022
5023 switch (e)
5024 {
5025 case WP_DELETED:
5026 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5027 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5028 /* Stop. */
5029 break;
5030 case WP_IGNORE:
5031 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5032 bs->stop = 0;
5033 break;
5034 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5035 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5036 {
5037 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5038
5039 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5040 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5041 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5042 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5043 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5044 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5045 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5046 old value.
5047
5048 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5049 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5050 happen:
5051
5052 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5053 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5054 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5055 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5056
5057 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5058 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5059 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5060 watchpoint.
5061
5062 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5063 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5064 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5065 changes. This still gives false positives when
5066 the program writes the same value to memory as
5067 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5068 it for a read), but it's much better than
5069 nothing. */
5070
5071 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5072
5073 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5074 {
5075 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5076
5077 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5078 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5079 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5080 {
5081 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5082 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5083
5084 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5085 == watch_triggered_yes)
5086 {
5087 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5088 break;
5089 }
5090 }
5091 }
5092
5093 if (other_write_watchpoint
5094 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5095 {
5096 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5097 and the value changed since the last time we
5098 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5099 Ignore it. */
5100 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5101 bs->stop = 0;
5102 }
5103 }
5104 break;
5105 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5106 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5107 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5108 {
5109 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5110 the value hasn't changed. */
5111 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5112 bs->stop = 0;
5113 }
5114 /* Stop. */
5115 break;
5116 default:
5117 /* Can't happen. */
5118 break;
5119 }
5120 }
5121 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5122 {
5123 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5124 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5125 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5126 anything for this watchpoint. */
5127 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5128 bs->stop = 0;
5129 }
5130 }
5131 }
5132
5133 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5134 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5135 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5136 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5137
5138 static void
5139 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5140 {
5141 const struct bp_location *bl;
5142 struct breakpoint *b;
5143 /* Assume stop. */
5144 bool condition_result = true;
5145 struct expression *cond;
5146
5147 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5148
5149 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5150 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5151 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5152 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5153 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5154
5155 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5156 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5157 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5158
5159 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5160 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5161 {
5162 bs->stop = 0;
5163 return;
5164 }
5165
5166 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5167 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5168 thread/task. */
5169 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5170 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5171 {
5172 bs->stop = 0;
5173 return;
5174 }
5175
5176 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5177 implemented. */
5178 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5179
5180 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5181 {
5182 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5183
5184 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5185 }
5186 else
5187 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5188
5189 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5190 {
5191 int within_current_scope = 1;
5192 struct watchpoint * w;
5193
5194 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5195 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5196 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5197 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5198 function call. */
5199 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5200
5201 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5202 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5203 else
5204 w = NULL;
5205
5206 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5207 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5208 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5209 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5210 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5211 call site. */
5212 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5213 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5214 else
5215 {
5216 struct frame_info *frame;
5217
5218 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5219 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5220 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5221 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5222 really matter which instantiation of the function
5223 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5224 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5225 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5226 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5227 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5228 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5229 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5230 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5231 intuitive. */
5232 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5233 if (frame != NULL)
5234 select_frame (frame);
5235 else
5236 within_current_scope = 0;
5237 }
5238 if (within_current_scope)
5239 {
5240 try
5241 {
5242 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5243 }
5244 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5245 {
5246 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5247 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5248 }
5249 }
5250 else
5251 {
5252 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5253 "in the current scope"));
5254 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5255 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5256 }
5257 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5258 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5259 }
5260
5261 if (cond && !condition_result)
5262 {
5263 bs->stop = 0;
5264 }
5265 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5266 {
5267 b->ignore_count--;
5268 bs->stop = 0;
5269 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5270 ++(b->hit_count);
5271 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5272 }
5273 }
5274
5275 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5276 on the current target. */
5277
5278 static int
5279 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5280 {
5281 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5282 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5283 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5284 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5285 }
5286
5287 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5288
5289 bpstat
5290 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5291 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5292 {
5293 struct breakpoint *b;
5294 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5295
5296 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5297 {
5298 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5299 continue;
5300
5301 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5302 {
5303 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5304 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5305 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5306 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5307 checked all locations already. */
5308 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5309 break;
5310
5311 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5312 continue;
5313
5314 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5315 continue;
5316
5317 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5318 matches. */
5319
5320 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5321 explain stop. */
5322
5323 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5324 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5325 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5326 bs->stop = 1;
5327 bs->print = 1;
5328
5329 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5330 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5331 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5332 iteration. */
5333 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5334 {
5335 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5336
5337 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5338 }
5339 }
5340 }
5341
5342 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5343 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5344 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5345 {
5346 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5347 {
5348 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5349 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5350 {
5351 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5352 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5353 bs->stop = 0;
5354 bs->print = 0;
5355 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5356 }
5357 }
5358 }
5359
5360 return bs_head;
5361 }
5362
5363 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5364
5365 bpstat
5366 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5367 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5368 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5369 bpstat stop_chain)
5370 {
5371 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5372 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5373 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5374 bpstat bs;
5375 int need_remove_insert;
5376 int removed_any;
5377
5378 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5379 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5380 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5381 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5382 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5383 inferior function calls. */
5384 if (bs_head == NULL)
5385 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5386
5387 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5388 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5389 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5390 "catch unload". */
5391 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5392 {
5393 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5394 {
5395 handle_solib_event ();
5396 break;
5397 }
5398 }
5399
5400 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5401 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5402 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5403
5404 removed_any = 0;
5405
5406 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5407 {
5408 if (!bs->stop)
5409 continue;
5410
5411 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5412 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5413 if (bs->stop)
5414 {
5415 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5416
5417 if (bs->stop)
5418 {
5419 ++(b->hit_count);
5420 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5421
5422 /* We will stop here. */
5423 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5424 {
5425 --(b->enable_count);
5426 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5427 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5428 removed_any = 1;
5429 }
5430 if (b->silent)
5431 bs->print = 0;
5432 bs->commands = b->commands;
5433 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5434 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5435 bs->print = 0;
5436
5437 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5438 }
5439
5440 }
5441
5442 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5443 print. */
5444 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5445 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5446 }
5447
5448 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5449 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5450 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5451 done later. */
5452 need_remove_insert = 0;
5453 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5454 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5455 if (!bs->stop
5456 && bs->breakpoint_at
5457 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5458 {
5459 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5460
5461 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5462 need_remove_insert = 1;
5463 }
5464
5465 if (need_remove_insert)
5466 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5467 else if (removed_any)
5468 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5469
5470 return bs_head;
5471 }
5472
5473 static void
5474 handle_jit_event (void)
5475 {
5476 struct frame_info *frame;
5477 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5478
5479 if (debug_infrun)
5480 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5481
5482 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5483 breakpoint_re_set. */
5484 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5485
5486 frame = get_current_frame ();
5487 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5488
5489 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5490
5491 target_terminal::inferior ();
5492 }
5493
5494 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5495
5496 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5497
5498 struct bpstat_what
5499 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5500 {
5501 struct bpstat_what retval;
5502 bpstat bs;
5503
5504 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5505 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5506 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5507
5508 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5509 {
5510 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5511 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5512 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5513 enum bptype bptype;
5514
5515 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5516 {
5517 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5518 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5519 bptype = bp_none;
5520 }
5521 else
5522 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5523
5524 switch (bptype)
5525 {
5526 case bp_none:
5527 break;
5528 case bp_breakpoint:
5529 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5530 case bp_single_step:
5531 case bp_until:
5532 case bp_finish:
5533 case bp_shlib_event:
5534 if (bs->stop)
5535 {
5536 if (bs->print)
5537 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5538 else
5539 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5540 }
5541 else
5542 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5543 break;
5544 case bp_watchpoint:
5545 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5546 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5547 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5548 if (bs->stop)
5549 {
5550 if (bs->print)
5551 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5552 else
5553 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5554 }
5555 else
5556 {
5557 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5558 This requires no further action. */
5559 }
5560 break;
5561 case bp_longjmp:
5562 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5563 case bp_exception:
5564 if (bs->stop)
5565 {
5566 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5567 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5568 }
5569 else
5570 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5571 break;
5572 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5573 case bp_exception_resume:
5574 if (bs->stop)
5575 {
5576 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5577 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5578 }
5579 else
5580 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5581 break;
5582 case bp_step_resume:
5583 if (bs->stop)
5584 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5585 else
5586 {
5587 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5588 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5589 }
5590 break;
5591 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5592 if (bs->stop)
5593 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5594 else
5595 {
5596 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5597 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5598 }
5599 break;
5600 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5601 case bp_thread_event:
5602 case bp_overlay_event:
5603 case bp_longjmp_master:
5604 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5605 case bp_exception_master:
5606 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5607 break;
5608 case bp_catchpoint:
5609 if (bs->stop)
5610 {
5611 if (bs->print)
5612 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5613 else
5614 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5615 }
5616 else
5617 {
5618 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5619 This requires no further action. */
5620 }
5621 break;
5622 case bp_jit_event:
5623 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5624 break;
5625 case bp_call_dummy:
5626 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5627 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5628 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5629 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5630 break;
5631 case bp_std_terminate:
5632 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5633 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5634 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5635 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5636 break;
5637 case bp_tracepoint:
5638 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5639 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5640 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5641 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5642 out already. */
5643 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5644 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5645 break;
5646 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5647 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5648 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5649 break;
5650 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5651 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5652 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5654 break;
5655
5656 case bp_dprintf:
5657 if (bs->stop)
5658 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5659 else
5660 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5661 break;
5662
5663 default:
5664 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5665 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5666 }
5667
5668 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5669 }
5670
5671 return retval;
5672 }
5673
5674 void
5675 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5676 {
5677 bpstat bs;
5678
5679 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5680 {
5681 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5682
5683 if (b == NULL)
5684 continue;
5685 switch (b->type)
5686 {
5687 case bp_jit_event:
5688 handle_jit_event ();
5689 break;
5690 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5691 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5692 break;
5693 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5694 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5695 break;
5696 }
5697 }
5698 }
5699
5700 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5701 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5702 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5703
5704 int
5705 bpstat_should_step (void)
5706 {
5707 struct breakpoint *b;
5708
5709 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5710 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5711 return 1;
5712 return 0;
5713 }
5714
5715 int
5716 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5717 {
5718 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5719 if (bs->stop)
5720 return 1;
5721
5722 return 0;
5723 }
5724
5725 \f
5726
5727 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5728 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5729 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5730
5731 static char *
5732 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5733 {
5734 static char wrap_indent[80];
5735 int i, total_width, width, align;
5736 const char *text;
5737
5738 total_width = 0;
5739 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5740 {
5741 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5742 {
5743 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5744 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5745 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5746
5747 return wrap_indent;
5748 }
5749
5750 total_width += width + 1;
5751 }
5752
5753 return NULL;
5754 }
5755
5756 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5757 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5758
5759 "host": Host evals condition.
5760 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5761 "target": Target evals condition.
5762 */
5763
5764 static const char *
5765 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5766 {
5767 struct bp_location *bl;
5768 char host_evals = 0;
5769 char target_evals = 0;
5770
5771 if (!b)
5772 return NULL;
5773
5774 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5775 return NULL;
5776
5777 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5778 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5779 return condition_evaluation_host;
5780
5781 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5782 {
5783 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5784 target_evals++;
5785 else
5786 host_evals++;
5787 }
5788
5789 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5790 return condition_evaluation_both;
5791 else if (target_evals)
5792 return condition_evaluation_target;
5793 else
5794 return condition_evaluation_host;
5795 }
5796
5797 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5798 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5799
5800 static const char *
5801 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5802 {
5803 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5804 return NULL;
5805
5806 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5807 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5808 return condition_evaluation_host;
5809
5810 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5811 return condition_evaluation_target;
5812 else
5813 return condition_evaluation_host;
5814 }
5815
5816 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5817
5818 static void
5819 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5820 struct bp_location *loc)
5821 {
5822 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5823
5824 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5825
5826 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5827 loc = NULL;
5828
5829 if (loc != NULL)
5830 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5831
5832 if (b->display_canonical)
5833 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5834 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5835 {
5836 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5837
5838 if (sym)
5839 {
5840 uiout->text ("in ");
5841 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
5842 ui_out_style_kind::FUNCTION);
5843 uiout->text (" ");
5844 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5845 uiout->text ("at ");
5846 }
5847 uiout->field_string ("file",
5848 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5849 ui_out_style_kind::FILE);
5850 uiout->text (":");
5851
5852 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5853 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5854
5855 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5856 }
5857 else if (loc)
5858 {
5859 string_file stb;
5860
5861 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5862 demangle, "");
5863 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5864 }
5865 else
5866 {
5867 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5868 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5869 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5870 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5871 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5872 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5873 {
5874 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5875 uiout->text (",");
5876 else
5877 uiout->text (" ");
5878 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5879 }
5880 }
5881
5882 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5883 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5884 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5885 {
5886 uiout->text (" (");
5887 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5888 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5889 uiout->text (")");
5890 }
5891 }
5892
5893 static const char *
5894 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5895 {
5896 struct ep_type_description
5897 {
5898 enum bptype type;
5899 const char *description;
5900 };
5901 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5902 {
5903 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5904 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5905 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5906 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5907 {bp_until, "until"},
5908 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5909 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5910 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5911 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5912 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5913 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5914 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5915 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5916 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5917 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5918 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5919 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5920 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5921 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5922 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5923 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5924 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5925 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5926 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5927 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5928 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5929 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5930 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5931 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5932 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5933 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5934 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5935 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5936 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5937 };
5938
5939 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5940 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5941 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5942 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5943 (int) type);
5944
5945 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5946 }
5947
5948 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5949 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5950
5951 static void
5952 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5953 const char *field_name,
5954 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5955 int mi_only)
5956 {
5957 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5958
5959 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5960 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5961 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5962 return;
5963
5964 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5965
5966 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5967 {
5968 if (is_mi)
5969 {
5970 char mi_group[10];
5971
5972 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
5973 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
5974 }
5975 else
5976 {
5977 if (i == 0)
5978 uiout->text (" inf ");
5979 else
5980 uiout->text (", ");
5981
5982 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
5983 }
5984 }
5985 }
5986
5987 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
5988
5989 static void
5990 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5991 struct bp_location *loc,
5992 int loc_number,
5993 struct bp_location **last_loc,
5994 int allflag)
5995 {
5996 struct command_line *l;
5997 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
5998
5999 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6000 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6001 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6002 struct value_print_options opts;
6003
6004 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6005
6006 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6007 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6008 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6009 if (loc == NULL
6010 && (b->loc != NULL
6011 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6012 header_of_multiple = 1;
6013 if (loc == NULL)
6014 loc = b->loc;
6015
6016 annotate_record ();
6017
6018 /* 1 */
6019 annotate_field (0);
6020 if (part_of_multiple)
6021 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6022 else
6023 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6024
6025 /* 2 */
6026 annotate_field (1);
6027 if (part_of_multiple)
6028 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6029 else
6030 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6031
6032 /* 3 */
6033 annotate_field (2);
6034 if (part_of_multiple)
6035 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6036 else
6037 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6038
6039 /* 4 */
6040 annotate_field (3);
6041 if (part_of_multiple)
6042 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6043 else
6044 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6045
6046 /* 5 and 6 */
6047 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6048 {
6049 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6050 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6051 make sure there's just one location. */
6052 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6053 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6054 }
6055 else
6056 switch (b->type)
6057 {
6058 case bp_none:
6059 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6060 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6061 break;
6062
6063 case bp_watchpoint:
6064 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6065 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6066 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6067 {
6068 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6069
6070 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6071 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6072 is relatively readable). */
6073 if (opts.addressprint)
6074 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6075 annotate_field (5);
6076 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6077 }
6078 break;
6079
6080 case bp_breakpoint:
6081 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6082 case bp_single_step:
6083 case bp_until:
6084 case bp_finish:
6085 case bp_longjmp:
6086 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6087 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6088 case bp_exception:
6089 case bp_exception_resume:
6090 case bp_step_resume:
6091 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6092 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6093 case bp_call_dummy:
6094 case bp_std_terminate:
6095 case bp_shlib_event:
6096 case bp_thread_event:
6097 case bp_overlay_event:
6098 case bp_longjmp_master:
6099 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6100 case bp_exception_master:
6101 case bp_tracepoint:
6102 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6103 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6104 case bp_dprintf:
6105 case bp_jit_event:
6106 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6107 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6108 if (opts.addressprint)
6109 {
6110 annotate_field (4);
6111 if (header_of_multiple)
6112 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6113 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6114 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6115 else
6116 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6117 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6118 }
6119 annotate_field (5);
6120 if (!header_of_multiple)
6121 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6122 if (b->loc)
6123 *last_loc = b->loc;
6124 break;
6125 }
6126
6127
6128 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6129 {
6130 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6131 int mi_only = 1;
6132
6133 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6134 {
6135 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6136 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6137 }
6138
6139 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6140 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6141 if (allflag
6142 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6143 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6144 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6145 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6146 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6147 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6148 mi_only = 0;
6149 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6150 }
6151
6152 if (!part_of_multiple)
6153 {
6154 if (b->thread != -1)
6155 {
6156 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6157 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6158 uiout->text (" thread ");
6159 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6160 }
6161 else if (b->task != 0)
6162 {
6163 uiout->text (" task ");
6164 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6165 }
6166 }
6167
6168 uiout->text ("\n");
6169
6170 if (!part_of_multiple)
6171 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6172
6173 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6174 {
6175 annotate_field (6);
6176 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6177 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6178 the frame ID. */
6179 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6180 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6181 uiout->text ("\n");
6182 }
6183
6184 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6185 {
6186 annotate_field (7);
6187 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6188 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6189 else
6190 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6191 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6192
6193 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6194 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6195 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6196 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6197 == condition_evaluation_target)
6198 {
6199 uiout->text (" (");
6200 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6201 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6202 uiout->text (" evals)");
6203 }
6204 uiout->text ("\n");
6205 }
6206
6207 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6208 {
6209 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6210 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6211 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6212 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6213 else
6214 {
6215 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6216
6217 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6218 }
6219 uiout->text ("\n");
6220 }
6221
6222 if (!part_of_multiple)
6223 {
6224 if (b->hit_count)
6225 {
6226 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6227 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6228 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6229 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6230 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6231 else
6232 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6233 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6234 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6235 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6236 uiout->text (" time\n");
6237 else
6238 uiout->text (" times\n");
6239 }
6240 else
6241 {
6242 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6243 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6244 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6245 }
6246 }
6247
6248 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6249 {
6250 annotate_field (8);
6251 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6252 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6253 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6254 }
6255
6256 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6257 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6258 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6259 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6260 {
6261 annotate_field (8);
6262 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6263 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6264 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6265 if (b->ignore_count)
6266 uiout->text ("additional ");
6267 else
6268 uiout->text ("next ");
6269 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6270 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6271 }
6272
6273 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6274 {
6275 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6276
6277 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6278 {
6279 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6280 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6281 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6282 }
6283 }
6284
6285 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6286 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6287 {
6288 annotate_field (9);
6289 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6290 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6291 }
6292
6293 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6294 {
6295 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6296
6297 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6298 {
6299 annotate_field (10);
6300 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6301 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6302 uiout->text (" \n");
6303 }
6304
6305 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6306 pending. */
6307 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6308 {
6309 annotate_field (11);
6310
6311 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6312 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6313 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6314 else
6315 {
6316 if (loc->inserted)
6317 uiout->text ("\t");
6318 else
6319 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6320 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6321 }
6322 }
6323 }
6324
6325 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6326 {
6327 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6328 {
6329 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6330
6331 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6332 }
6333 else if (b->location != NULL
6334 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6335 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6336 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6337 }
6338 }
6339
6340 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6341
6342 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
6343
6344 static void
6345 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6346 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6347 int allflag)
6348 {
6349 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6350 bool use_fixed_output
6351 = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
6352 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
6353
6354 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
6355 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6356
6357 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6358 are outside. */
6359 if (!use_fixed_output)
6360 bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
6361
6362 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6363 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6364 locations, if any. */
6365 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6366 {
6367 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6368 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6369 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6370 situation.
6371
6372 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6373 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6374 if (b->loc
6375 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6376 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6377 {
6378 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
6379
6380 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6381 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6382 list. */
6383 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
6384 locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
6385
6386 int n = 1;
6387 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6388 {
6389 ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6390 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6391 }
6392 }
6393 }
6394 }
6395
6396 static int
6397 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6398 {
6399 int print_address_bits = 0;
6400 struct bp_location *loc;
6401
6402 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6403 address to print. */
6404 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6405 return 0;
6406
6407 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6408 {
6409 int addr_bit;
6410
6411 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6412 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6413 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6414 }
6415
6416 return print_address_bits;
6417 }
6418
6419 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6420
6421 void
6422 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6423 {
6424 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6425 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6426 }
6427
6428 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6429 internal or momentary. */
6430
6431 int
6432 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6433 {
6434 return b->number > 0;
6435 }
6436
6437 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6438
6439 int
6440 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6441 {
6442 return b->loc == NULL;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6446 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6447 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6448 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6449 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6450 breakpoints listed. */
6451
6452 static int
6453 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6454 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6455 {
6456 struct breakpoint *b;
6457 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6458 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6459 struct value_print_options opts;
6460 int print_address_bits = 0;
6461 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6462 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6463
6464 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6465
6466 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6467 required for address fields. */
6468 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6469 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6470 {
6471 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6472 if (filter && !filter (b))
6473 continue;
6474
6475 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6476 accept. Skip the others. */
6477 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6478 {
6479 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6480 continue;
6481 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6482 continue;
6483 }
6484
6485 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6486 {
6487 int addr_bit, type_len;
6488
6489 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6490 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6491 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6492
6493 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6494 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6495 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6496
6497 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6498 }
6499 }
6500
6501 {
6502 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6503 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6504 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6505 "BreakpointTable");
6506
6507 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6508 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6509 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6510 annotate_field (0);
6511 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6512 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6513 annotate_field (1);
6514 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6515 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6516 annotate_field (2);
6517 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6518 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6519 annotate_field (3);
6520 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6521 if (opts.addressprint)
6522 {
6523 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6524 annotate_field (4);
6525 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6526 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6527 else
6528 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6529 }
6530 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6531 annotate_field (5);
6532 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6533 uiout->table_body ();
6534 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6535 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6536
6537 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6538 {
6539 QUIT;
6540 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6541 if (filter && !filter (b))
6542 continue;
6543
6544 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6545 accept. Skip the others. */
6546
6547 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6548 {
6549 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6550 {
6551 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6552 continue;
6553 }
6554 else /* all others */
6555 {
6556 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6557 continue;
6558 }
6559 }
6560 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6561 allflag is set. */
6562 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6563 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6564 }
6565 }
6566
6567 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6568 {
6569 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6570 empty list. */
6571 if (!filter)
6572 {
6573 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6574 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6575 else
6576 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6577 args);
6578 }
6579 }
6580 else
6581 {
6582 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6583 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6584 }
6585
6586 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6587 there have been breakpoints? */
6588 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6589
6590 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6591 }
6592
6593 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6594 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6595
6596 static void
6597 default_collect_info (void)
6598 {
6599 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6600
6601 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6602 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6603 not wanted. */
6604 if (!*default_collect)
6605 return;
6606
6607 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6608 actions. */
6609 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6610 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6611 uiout->text (" \n");
6612 }
6613
6614 static void
6615 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6616 {
6617 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6618
6619 default_collect_info ();
6620 }
6621
6622 static void
6623 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6624 {
6625 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6626 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6627
6628 if (num_printed == 0)
6629 {
6630 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6631 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6632 else
6633 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6634 }
6635 }
6636
6637 static void
6638 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6639 {
6640 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6641
6642 default_collect_info ();
6643 }
6644
6645 static int
6646 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6647 struct program_space *pspace,
6648 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6649 {
6650 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6651
6652 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6653 {
6654 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6655 && bl->address == pc
6656 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6657 return 1;
6658 }
6659 return 0;
6660 }
6661
6662 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6663 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6664 address spaces. */
6665
6666 static void
6667 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6668 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6669 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6670 {
6671 int others = 0;
6672 struct breakpoint *b;
6673
6674 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6675 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6676 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6677 if (others > 0)
6678 {
6679 if (others == 1)
6680 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6681 else /* if (others == ???) */
6682 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6683 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6684 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6685 {
6686 others--;
6687 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6688 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6689 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6690 else if (b->thread != -1)
6691 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6692 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6693 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6694 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6695 ? " (disabled)"
6696 : ""),
6697 (others > 1) ? ","
6698 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6699 }
6700 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6701 fputs_styled (paddress (gdbarch, pc), address_style.style (), gdb_stdout);
6702 printf_filtered (".\n");
6703 }
6704 }
6705 \f
6706
6707 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6708 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6709 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6710 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6711
6712 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6713 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6714 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6715 breakpoint location at address zero:
6716
6717 bp_watchpoint
6718 bp_catchpoint
6719
6720 */
6721
6722 static int
6723 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6724 {
6725 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6726
6727 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6728 }
6729
6730 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6731 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6732
6733 static int
6734 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6735 struct bp_location *loc2)
6736 {
6737 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6738 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6739
6740 /* Both of them must exist. */
6741 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6742 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6743
6744 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6745 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6746 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6747 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6748 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6749 other watchpoint. */
6750 if ((w1->cond_exp
6751 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6752 loc1->length,
6753 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6754 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6755 || (w2->cond_exp
6756 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6757 loc2->length,
6758 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6759 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6760 return 0;
6761
6762 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6763 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6764 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6765 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6766 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6767 become hw_access locations later. */
6768 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6769 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6770 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6771 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6772 }
6773
6774 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6775
6776 int
6777 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6778 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6779 {
6780 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6781 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6782 && addr1 == addr2);
6783 }
6784
6785 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6786 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6787 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6788 space doesn't really matter. */
6789
6790 static int
6791 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6792 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6793 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6794 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6795 {
6796 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6797 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6798 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6799 }
6800
6801 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6802 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6803 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6804 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6805
6806 static int
6807 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6808 const address_space *aspace,
6809 CORE_ADDR addr)
6810 {
6811 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6812 aspace, addr)
6813 || (bl->length
6814 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6815 bl->address, bl->length,
6816 aspace, addr)));
6817 }
6818
6819 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6820 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6821 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6822 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6823 doesn't really matter. */
6824
6825 static int
6826 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6827 const address_space *aspace,
6828 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6829 {
6830 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6831 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6832 {
6833 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6834
6835 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6836 return 1;
6837 }
6838 return 0;
6839 }
6840
6841 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6842 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6843 true, otherwise returns false. */
6844
6845 static int
6846 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6847 struct bp_location *loc2)
6848 {
6849 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6850 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6851 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6852 different locations. */
6853 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6854 else
6855 return 0;
6856 }
6857
6858 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6859 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6860 represent the same location. */
6861
6862 static int
6863 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6864 struct bp_location *loc2)
6865 {
6866 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6867
6868 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6869 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6870 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6871
6872 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6873 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6874
6875 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6876 return 0;
6877 else if (hw_point1)
6878 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6879 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6880 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6881 else
6882 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6883 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6884 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6885 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6886 }
6887
6888 static void
6889 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6890 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6891 {
6892 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6893 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6894 char astr1[64];
6895 char astr2[64];
6896
6897 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6898 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6899 if (have_bnum)
6900 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6901 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6902 else
6903 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6904 }
6905
6906 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6907 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6908 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6909 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6910
6911 static CORE_ADDR
6912 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6913 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6914 {
6915 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6916 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6917 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6918 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6919 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6920 {
6921 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6922 have their addresses modified. */
6923 return bpaddr;
6924 }
6925 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6926 {
6927 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6928 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6929 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6930 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6931 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6932 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6933 return bpaddr;
6934 }
6935 else
6936 {
6937 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6938
6939 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6940 {
6941 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6942 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6943 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6944 }
6945
6946 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6947
6948 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6949 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6950 is required. */
6951 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6952 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6953
6954 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6955 }
6956 }
6957
6958 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
6959 {
6960 bp_location *loc = this;
6961
6962 loc->owner = owner;
6963 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6964 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6965 loc->enabled = 1;
6966
6967 switch (owner->type)
6968 {
6969 case bp_breakpoint:
6970 case bp_single_step:
6971 case bp_until:
6972 case bp_finish:
6973 case bp_longjmp:
6974 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6975 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6976 case bp_exception:
6977 case bp_exception_resume:
6978 case bp_step_resume:
6979 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6980 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6981 case bp_call_dummy:
6982 case bp_std_terminate:
6983 case bp_shlib_event:
6984 case bp_thread_event:
6985 case bp_overlay_event:
6986 case bp_jit_event:
6987 case bp_longjmp_master:
6988 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6989 case bp_exception_master:
6990 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6991 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6992 case bp_dprintf:
6993 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
6994 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
6995 break;
6996 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6997 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
6998 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
6999 break;
7000 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7001 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7002 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7003 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7004 break;
7005 case bp_watchpoint:
7006 case bp_catchpoint:
7007 case bp_tracepoint:
7008 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7009 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7010 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7011 break;
7012 default:
7013 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7014 }
7015
7016 loc->refc = 1;
7017 }
7018
7019 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7020
7021 static struct bp_location *
7022 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7023 {
7024 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7025 }
7026
7027 static void
7028 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7029 {
7030 delete loc;
7031 }
7032
7033 /* Increment reference count. */
7034
7035 static void
7036 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7037 {
7038 ++bl->refc;
7039 }
7040
7041 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7042 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7043
7044 static void
7045 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7046 {
7047 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7048
7049 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7050 free_bp_location (*blp);
7051 *blp = NULL;
7052 }
7053
7054 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7055
7056 static breakpoint *
7057 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7058 {
7059 struct breakpoint *b1;
7060 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7061
7062 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7063 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7064
7065 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7066 if (b1 == 0)
7067 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7068 else
7069 {
7070 while (b1->next)
7071 b1 = b1->next;
7072 b1->next = b.release ();
7073 }
7074
7075 return result;
7076 }
7077
7078 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7079
7080 static void
7081 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7082 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7083 enum bptype bptype,
7084 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7085 {
7086 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7087
7088 b->ops = ops;
7089 b->type = bptype;
7090 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7091 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7092 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7093 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7094 }
7095
7096 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7097 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7098
7099 static struct breakpoint *
7100 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7101 enum bptype bptype,
7102 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7103 {
7104 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7105
7106 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7107 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7108 }
7109
7110 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7111 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7112 enough. */
7113
7114 static void
7115 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7116 {
7117 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7118
7119 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7120 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7121 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7122 {
7123 const char *function_name;
7124
7125 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7126 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7127 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)
7128 && !explicit_loc)
7129 {
7130 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7131
7132 function_name = MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (loc->msymbol);
7133
7134 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7135 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7136 {
7137 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7138 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7139 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7140 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7141 breakpoint. */
7142 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7143 }
7144 }
7145 else
7146 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7147
7148 if (function_name)
7149 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7150 }
7151 }
7152
7153 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7154 struct gdbarch *
7155 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7156 {
7157 if (sal.section)
7158 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7159 if (sal.symtab)
7160 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7161
7162 return NULL;
7163 }
7164
7165 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7166 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7167 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7168
7169 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7170 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7171 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7172
7173 static void
7174 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7175 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7176 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7177 {
7178 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7179
7180 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7181
7182 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7183 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7184
7185 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7186 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7187 program space. */
7188 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7189 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7190 }
7191
7192 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7193 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7194 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7195 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7196 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7197 is also returned as the value of this function.
7198
7199 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7200 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7201 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7202 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7203 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7204 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7205 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7206
7207 struct breakpoint *
7208 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7209 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7210 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7211 {
7212 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7213
7214 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7215 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7216 }
7217
7218 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7219 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7220 initiated the operation. */
7221
7222 void
7223 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7224 {
7225 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7226 int thread = tp->global_num;
7227
7228 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7229 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7230 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7231 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7232 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7233 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7234 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7235 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7236 {
7237 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7238 struct breakpoint *clone;
7239
7240 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7241 after their removal. */
7242 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7243 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7244 clone->thread = thread;
7245 }
7246
7247 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7248 }
7249
7250 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7251 void
7252 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7253 {
7254 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7255
7256 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7257 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7258 {
7259 if (b->thread == thread)
7260 delete_breakpoint (b);
7261 }
7262 }
7263
7264 void
7265 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7266 {
7267 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7268
7269 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7270 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7271 {
7272 if (b->thread == thread)
7273 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7274 }
7275 }
7276
7277 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7278 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7279 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7280 breakpoints. */
7281
7282 struct breakpoint *
7283 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7284 {
7285 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7286
7287 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7288 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7289 {
7290 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7291
7292 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7293 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7294 1);
7295 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7296
7297 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7298
7299 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7300 if (retval == NULL)
7301 retval = new_b;
7302 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7303 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7304 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7305 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7306 }
7307
7308 return retval;
7309 }
7310
7311 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7312 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7313 stack.
7314
7315 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7316 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7317 frames. */
7318
7319 void
7320 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7321 {
7322 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7323
7324 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7325 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7326 {
7327 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7328
7329 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7330 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7331 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7332 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7333 continue;
7334
7335 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7336
7337 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7338 {
7339 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7340 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7341 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7342 }
7343 delete_breakpoint (b);
7344 }
7345 }
7346
7347 void
7348 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7349 {
7350 struct breakpoint *b;
7351
7352 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7353 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7354 {
7355 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7356 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7357 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7358 }
7359 }
7360
7361 void
7362 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7363 {
7364 struct breakpoint *b;
7365
7366 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7367 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7368 {
7369 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7370 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7371 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7372 }
7373 }
7374
7375 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7376 master breakpoint. */
7377 void
7378 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7379 {
7380 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7381
7382 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7383 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7384 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7385 {
7386 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7387 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7388 }
7389 }
7390
7391 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7392 void
7393 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7394 {
7395 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7396
7397 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7398 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7399 delete_breakpoint (b);
7400 }
7401
7402 struct breakpoint *
7403 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7404 {
7405 struct breakpoint *b;
7406
7407 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7408 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7409
7410 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7411 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7412 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7413
7414 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7415
7416 return b;
7417 }
7418
7419 struct lang_and_radix
7420 {
7421 enum language lang;
7422 int radix;
7423 };
7424
7425 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7426
7427 struct breakpoint *
7428 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7429 {
7430 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7431 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7432 }
7433
7434 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7435
7436 void
7437 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7438 {
7439 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7440
7441 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7442 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7443 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7444 delete_breakpoint (b);
7445 }
7446
7447 void
7448 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7449 {
7450 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7451
7452 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7453 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7454 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7455 delete_breakpoint (b);
7456 }
7457
7458 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7459
7460 void
7461 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7462 {
7463 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7464
7465 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7466 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7467 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7468 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7469 }
7470
7471 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7472 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7473 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7474
7475 static struct breakpoint *
7476 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7477 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7478 {
7479 struct breakpoint *b;
7480
7481 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7482 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7483 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7484 return b;
7485 }
7486
7487 struct breakpoint *
7488 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7489 {
7490 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7491 }
7492
7493 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7494
7495 struct breakpoint *
7496 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7497 {
7498 struct breakpoint *b;
7499
7500 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7501 locations. */
7502 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7503 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7504 {
7505 delete_breakpoint (b);
7506 return NULL;
7507 }
7508 return b;
7509 }
7510
7511 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7512 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7513
7514 void
7515 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7516 {
7517 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7518
7519 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7520 {
7521 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7522 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7523
7524 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7525 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7526 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7527 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7528 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7529 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7530 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7531 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7532 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7533 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7534 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7535 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7536 )
7537 {
7538 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7539 }
7540 }
7541 }
7542
7543 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7544 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7545 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7546
7547 static void
7548 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7549 {
7550 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7551 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7552
7553 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7554 {
7555 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7556 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7557
7558 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7559 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7560 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7561 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7562 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7563 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7564 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7565 || is_tracepoint (b))
7566 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7567 {
7568 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7569 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7570 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7571 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7572 loc->inserted = 0;
7573
7574 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7575 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7576
7577 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7578 {
7579 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7580 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7581 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7582 solib->so_name);
7583 }
7584 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7585 }
7586 }
7587 }
7588
7589 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7590 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7591 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7592
7593 static void
7594 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7595 {
7596 struct breakpoint *b;
7597
7598 if (objfile == NULL)
7599 return;
7600
7601 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7602 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7603 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7604 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7605 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7606 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7607 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7608 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7609 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7610 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7611 main objfile). */
7612 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7613 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7614 return;
7615
7616 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7617 {
7618 struct bp_location *loc;
7619 int bp_modified = 0;
7620
7621 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7622 continue;
7623
7624 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7625 {
7626 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7627
7628 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7629 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7630 continue;
7631
7632 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7633 continue;
7634
7635 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7636 continue;
7637
7638 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7639 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7640 continue;
7641
7642 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7643 {
7644 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7645 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7646 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7647 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7648 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7649 unmapped. */
7650
7651 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7652
7653 bp_modified = 1;
7654 }
7655 }
7656
7657 if (bp_modified)
7658 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7659 }
7660 }
7661
7662 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7663
7664 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7665 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7666 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7667
7668 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7669 {
7670 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7671 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7672 catchpoint has triggered. */
7673 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7674 };
7675
7676 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7677 catchpoints. */
7678
7679 static int
7680 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7681 {
7682 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7683 }
7684
7685 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7686 catchpoints. */
7687
7688 static int
7689 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7690 {
7691 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7692 }
7693
7694 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7695 catchpoints. */
7696
7697 static int
7698 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7699 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7700 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7701 {
7702 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7703
7704 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7705 return 0;
7706
7707 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7708 return 1;
7709 }
7710
7711 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7712 catchpoints. */
7713
7714 static enum print_stop_action
7715 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7716 {
7717 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7718 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7719 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7720
7721 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7722 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7723 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7724 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7725 else
7726 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7727 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7728 {
7729 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7730 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7731 }
7732 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7733 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7734 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7735 uiout->text ("), ");
7736 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7737 }
7738
7739 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7740 catchpoints. */
7741
7742 static void
7743 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7744 {
7745 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7746 struct value_print_options opts;
7747 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7748
7749 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7750
7751 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7752 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7753 readable). */
7754 if (opts.addressprint)
7755 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7756 annotate_field (5);
7757 uiout->text ("fork");
7758 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7759 {
7760 uiout->text (", process ");
7761 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7762 uiout->spaces (1);
7763 }
7764
7765 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7766 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7767 }
7768
7769 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7770 catchpoints. */
7771
7772 static void
7773 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7774 {
7775 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7776 }
7777
7778 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7779 catchpoints. */
7780
7781 static void
7782 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7783 {
7784 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7785 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7786 }
7787
7788 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7789
7790 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7791
7792 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7793 catchpoints. */
7794
7795 static int
7796 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7797 {
7798 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7799 }
7800
7801 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7802 catchpoints. */
7803
7804 static int
7805 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7806 {
7807 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7808 }
7809
7810 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7811 catchpoints. */
7812
7813 static int
7814 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7815 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7816 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7817 {
7818 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7819
7820 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7821 return 0;
7822
7823 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7824 return 1;
7825 }
7826
7827 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7828 catchpoints. */
7829
7830 static enum print_stop_action
7831 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7832 {
7833 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7834 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7835 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7836
7837 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7838 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7839 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7840 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7841 else
7842 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7843 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7844 {
7845 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7846 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7847 }
7848 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7849 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7850 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7851 uiout->text ("), ");
7852 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7853 }
7854
7855 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7856 catchpoints. */
7857
7858 static void
7859 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7860 {
7861 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7862 struct value_print_options opts;
7863 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7864
7865 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7866 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7867 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7868 readable). */
7869 if (opts.addressprint)
7870 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7871 annotate_field (5);
7872 uiout->text ("vfork");
7873 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7874 {
7875 uiout->text (", process ");
7876 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7877 uiout->spaces (1);
7878 }
7879
7880 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7881 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7882 }
7883
7884 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7885 catchpoints. */
7886
7887 static void
7888 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7889 {
7890 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7891 }
7892
7893 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7894 catchpoints. */
7895
7896 static void
7897 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7898 {
7899 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7900 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7901 }
7902
7903 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7904
7905 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7906
7907 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7908 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7909 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7910
7911 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7912 {
7913 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7914
7915 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7916 unsigned char is_load;
7917
7918 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7919 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7920 char *regex;
7921 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7922 };
7923
7924 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7925 {
7926 xfree (this->regex);
7927 }
7928
7929 static int
7930 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7931 {
7932 return 0;
7933 }
7934
7935 static int
7936 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7937 {
7938 return 0;
7939 }
7940
7941 static int
7942 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7943 const address_space *aspace,
7944 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7945 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7946 {
7947 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7948 struct breakpoint *other;
7949
7950 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7951 return 1;
7952
7953 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7954 {
7955 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7956
7957 if (other == bl->owner)
7958 continue;
7959
7960 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7961 continue;
7962
7963 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7964 continue;
7965
7966 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7967 {
7968 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7969 return 1;
7970 }
7971 }
7972
7973 return 0;
7974 }
7975
7976 static void
7977 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
7978 {
7979 struct solib_catchpoint *self
7980 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7981
7982 if (self->is_load)
7983 {
7984 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
7985 {
7986 if (!self->regex
7987 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7988 return;
7989 }
7990 }
7991 else
7992 {
7993 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
7994 {
7995 if (!self->regex
7996 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
7997 return;
7998 }
7999 }
8000
8001 bs->stop = 0;
8002 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8003 }
8004
8005 static enum print_stop_action
8006 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8007 {
8008 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8009 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8010
8011 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8012 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8013 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8014 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8015 else
8016 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8017 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8018 uiout->text ("\n");
8019 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8020 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8021 print_solib_event (1);
8022 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8023 }
8024
8025 static void
8026 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8027 {
8028 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8029 struct value_print_options opts;
8030 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8031
8032 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8033 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8034 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8035 readable). */
8036 if (opts.addressprint)
8037 {
8038 annotate_field (4);
8039 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8040 }
8041
8042 std::string msg;
8043 annotate_field (5);
8044 if (self->is_load)
8045 {
8046 if (self->regex)
8047 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8048 else
8049 msg = _("load of library");
8050 }
8051 else
8052 {
8053 if (self->regex)
8054 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8055 else
8056 msg = _("unload of library");
8057 }
8058 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8059
8060 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8061 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8062 }
8063
8064 static void
8065 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8066 {
8067 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8068
8069 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8070 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8071 }
8072
8073 static void
8074 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8075 {
8076 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8077
8078 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8079 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8080 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8081 if (self->regex)
8082 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8083 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8084 }
8085
8086 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8087
8088 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8089 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8090 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8091 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8092 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8093 created in an enabled state. */
8094
8095 void
8096 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8097 {
8098 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8099
8100 if (!arg)
8101 arg = "";
8102 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8103
8104 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8105
8106 if (*arg != '\0')
8107 {
8108 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8109 _("Invalid regexp")));
8110 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8111 }
8112
8113 c->is_load = is_load;
8114 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8115 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8116
8117 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8118
8119 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8120 }
8121
8122 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8123 "catch unload". */
8124
8125 static void
8126 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8127 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8128 {
8129 int tempflag;
8130 const int enabled = 1;
8131
8132 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8133
8134 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8135 }
8136
8137 static void
8138 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8139 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8140 {
8141 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8142 }
8143
8144 static void
8145 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8146 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8147 {
8148 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8149 }
8150
8151 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8152 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8153 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8154 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8155
8156 void
8157 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8158 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8159 const char *cond_string,
8160 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8161 {
8162 symtab_and_line sal;
8163 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8164
8165 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8166
8167 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8168 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8169 }
8170
8171 void
8172 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8173 {
8174 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8175 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8176 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8177 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8178 if (!internal)
8179 mention (b);
8180 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8181
8182 if (update_gll)
8183 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8184 }
8185
8186 static void
8187 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8188 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8189 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8190 {
8191 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8192
8193 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8194
8195 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8196
8197 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8198 }
8199
8200 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8201
8202 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8203 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8204 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8205
8206 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8207 {
8208 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8209
8210 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8211 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8212 triggered. */
8213 char *exec_pathname;
8214 };
8215
8216 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8217
8218 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8219 {
8220 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8221 }
8222
8223 static int
8224 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8225 {
8226 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8227 }
8228
8229 static int
8230 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8231 {
8232 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8233 }
8234
8235 static int
8236 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8237 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8238 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8239 {
8240 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8241
8242 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8243 return 0;
8244
8245 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8246 return 1;
8247 }
8248
8249 static enum print_stop_action
8250 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8251 {
8252 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8253 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8254 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8255
8256 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8257 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8258 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8259 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8260 else
8261 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8262 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8263 {
8264 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8265 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8266 }
8267 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8268 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8269 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8270 uiout->text ("), ");
8271
8272 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8273 }
8274
8275 static void
8276 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8277 {
8278 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8279 struct value_print_options opts;
8280 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8281
8282 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8283
8284 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8285 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8286 is relatively readable). */
8287 if (opts.addressprint)
8288 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8289 annotate_field (5);
8290 uiout->text ("exec");
8291 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8292 {
8293 uiout->text (", program \"");
8294 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8295 uiout->text ("\" ");
8296 }
8297
8298 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8299 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8300 }
8301
8302 static void
8303 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8304 {
8305 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8306 }
8307
8308 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8309 catchpoints. */
8310
8311 static void
8312 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8313 {
8314 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8315 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8316 }
8317
8318 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8319
8320 static int
8321 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8322 {
8323 int i = 0;
8324 struct breakpoint *b;
8325 struct bp_location *bl;
8326
8327 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8328 {
8329 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8330 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8331 {
8332 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8333 one register. */
8334 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8335 }
8336 }
8337
8338 return i;
8339 }
8340
8341 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8342 watchpoint. */
8343
8344 static int
8345 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8346 {
8347 int i = 0;
8348 struct bp_location *bl;
8349
8350 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8351 return 0;
8352
8353 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8354 {
8355 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8356 one register. */
8357 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8358 }
8359
8360 return i;
8361 }
8362
8363 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8364 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8365 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8366 types _not_ TYPE. */
8367
8368 static int
8369 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8370 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8371 {
8372 int i = 0;
8373 struct breakpoint *b;
8374
8375 *other_type_used = 0;
8376 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8377 {
8378 if (b == except)
8379 continue;
8380 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8381 continue;
8382
8383 if (b->type == type)
8384 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8385 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8386 *other_type_used = 1;
8387 }
8388
8389 return i;
8390 }
8391
8392 void
8393 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8394 {
8395 struct breakpoint *b;
8396
8397 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8398 {
8399 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8400 {
8401 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8402 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8403 }
8404 }
8405 }
8406
8407 void
8408 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8409 {
8410 struct breakpoint *b;
8411
8412 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8413 {
8414 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8415 {
8416 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8417 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8418 }
8419 }
8420 }
8421
8422 void
8423 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8424 {
8425 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8426 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8427 }
8428
8429 void
8430 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8431 {
8432 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8433 breakpoint_re_set ();
8434 }
8435
8436 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8437 locations. */
8438
8439 static struct breakpoint *
8440 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8441 {
8442 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8443
8444 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8445 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8446
8447 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8448 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8449
8450 b->thread = thread;
8451 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8452
8453 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8454 }
8455
8456 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8457 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8458 frame. */
8459
8460 breakpoint_up
8461 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8462 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8463 {
8464 struct breakpoint *b;
8465
8466 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8467 tail-called one. */
8468 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8469
8470 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8471 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8472 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8473 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8474
8475 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8476
8477 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8478
8479 return breakpoint_up (b);
8480 }
8481
8482 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8483 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8484 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8485
8486 static struct breakpoint *
8487 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8488 enum bptype type,
8489 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8490 int loc_enabled)
8491 {
8492 struct breakpoint *copy;
8493
8494 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8495 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8496 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8497
8498 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8499 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8500 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8501 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8502 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8503 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8504 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8505 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8506 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8507 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8508 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8509 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8510
8511 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8512 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8513 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8514
8515 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8516 return copy;
8517 }
8518
8519 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8520 ORIG is NULL. */
8521
8522 struct breakpoint *
8523 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8524 {
8525 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8526 if (orig == NULL)
8527 return NULL;
8528
8529 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8530 }
8531
8532 breakpoint_up
8533 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8534 enum bptype type)
8535 {
8536 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8537
8538 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8539 sal.pc = pc;
8540 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8541 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8542
8543 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8544 }
8545 \f
8546
8547 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8548
8549 static void
8550 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8551 {
8552 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8553 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8554 }
8555 \f
8556
8557 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8558
8559 static struct bp_location *
8560 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8561 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8562 {
8563 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8564 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8565 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8566
8567 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8568 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8569
8570 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8571 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8572 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8573 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8574 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8575 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8576 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8577 sal->pc, b->type);
8578
8579 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8580 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8581 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8582 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8583 ;
8584 loc->next = *tmp;
8585 *tmp = loc;
8586
8587 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8588 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8589 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8590 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8591 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8592 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8593 loc->section = sal->section;
8594 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8595 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8596 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8597 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8598 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8599 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8600
8601 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8602 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8603
8604 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8605 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8606 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8607 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8608 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8609 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8610 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8611 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8612 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8613 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8614 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8615 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8616 instruction.) */
8617 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8618 loc->permanent = 1;
8619
8620 return loc;
8621 }
8622 \f
8623
8624 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8625
8626 int
8627 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8628 {
8629 int len;
8630 CORE_ADDR addr;
8631 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8632 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8633
8634 addr = address;
8635 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8636
8637 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8638 if (bpoint == NULL)
8639 return 0;
8640
8641 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8642
8643 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8644 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8645 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8646 scoped_restore restore_memory
8647 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8648
8649 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8650 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8651 return 1;
8652
8653 return 0;
8654 }
8655
8656 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8657 return 0 otherwise. */
8658
8659 static int
8660 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8661 {
8662 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8663
8664 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8665 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8666 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8667 memory. */
8668 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8669 return 0;
8670
8671 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8672 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8673 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8674 }
8675
8676 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8677 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8678
8679 static void
8680 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8681 {
8682 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8683 char *printf_line = NULL;
8684
8685 if (!dprintf_args)
8686 return;
8687
8688 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8689
8690 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8691 insist on it. */
8692 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8693 ++dprintf_args;
8694 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8695
8696 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8697 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8698
8699 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8700 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8701 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8702 {
8703 if (!dprintf_function)
8704 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8705
8706 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8707 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8708 dprintf_function,
8709 dprintf_channel,
8710 dprintf_args);
8711 else
8712 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8713 dprintf_function,
8714 dprintf_args);
8715 }
8716 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8717 {
8718 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8719 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8720 else
8721 {
8722 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8723 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8724 }
8725 }
8726 else
8727 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8728 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8729
8730 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8731
8732 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8733 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8734 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8735 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8736 command_lines_deleter ()));
8737 }
8738
8739 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8740 current style settings. */
8741
8742 static void
8743 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8744 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8745 {
8746 struct breakpoint *b;
8747
8748 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8749 {
8750 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8751 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8752 }
8753 }
8754
8755 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8756 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8757 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8758 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8759
8760 static void
8761 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8762 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8763 event_location_up &&location,
8764 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8765 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8766 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8767 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8768 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8769 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8770 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8771 int display_canonical)
8772 {
8773 int i;
8774
8775 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8776 {
8777 int target_resources_ok;
8778
8779 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8780 target_resources_ok =
8781 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8782 i + 1, 0);
8783 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8784 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8785 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8786 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8787 }
8788
8789 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8790
8791 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8792 {
8793 struct bp_location *loc;
8794
8795 if (from_tty)
8796 {
8797 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8798 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8799 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8800
8801 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8802 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8803 }
8804
8805 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8806 {
8807 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8808 b->thread = thread;
8809 b->task = task;
8810
8811 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8812 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8813 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8814 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8815 b->disposition = disposition;
8816
8817 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8818 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8819
8820 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8821 {
8822 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8823 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8824
8825 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8826 {
8827 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8828 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8829 const char *p
8830 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8831 const char *endp;
8832
8833 p = skip_spaces (p);
8834
8835 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8836
8837 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8838
8839 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8840 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8841 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8842 }
8843 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8844 {
8845 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8846
8847 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8848 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8849 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8850 }
8851 else
8852 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8853 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8854 }
8855
8856 loc = b->loc;
8857 }
8858 else
8859 {
8860 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8861 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8862 loc->inserted = 1;
8863 }
8864
8865 if (b->cond_string)
8866 {
8867 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8868
8869 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8870 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8871 if (*arg)
8872 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8873 }
8874
8875 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8876 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8877 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8878 {
8879 if (b->extra_string)
8880 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8881 else
8882 error (_("Format string required"));
8883 }
8884 else if (b->extra_string)
8885 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8886 }
8887
8888 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8889 if (location != NULL)
8890 b->location = std::move (location);
8891 else
8892 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8893 b->filter = filter.release ();
8894 }
8895
8896 static void
8897 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8898 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8899 event_location_up &&location,
8900 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8901 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8902 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8903 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8904 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8905 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8906 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8907 int display_canonical)
8908 {
8909 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8910
8911 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8912 sals, std::move (location),
8913 std::move (filter),
8914 std::move (cond_string),
8915 std::move (extra_string),
8916 type, disposition,
8917 thread, task, ignore_count,
8918 ops, from_tty,
8919 enabled, internal, flags,
8920 display_canonical);
8921
8922 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8923 }
8924
8925 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8926 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8927 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8928 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8929 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8930 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8931 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8932 we take just a single condition string.
8933
8934 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8935 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8936 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8937 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8938 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8939
8940 static void
8941 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8942 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8943 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8944 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8945 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8946 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8947 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8948 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8949 {
8950 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8951 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8952
8953 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8954 {
8955 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8956 'break', without arguments. */
8957 event_location_up location
8958 = (canonical->location != NULL
8959 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8960 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8961 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8962
8963 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8964 std::move (location),
8965 std::move (filter_string),
8966 std::move (cond_string),
8967 std::move (extra_string),
8968 type, disposition,
8969 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
8970 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
8971 canonical->special_display);
8972 }
8973 }
8974
8975 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
8976 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
8977 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
8978 linespec locations).
8979
8980 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
8981 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
8982
8983 static void
8984 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
8985 struct linespec_result *canonical)
8986 {
8987 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
8988
8989 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
8990 {
8991 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
8992
8993 if (spec == NULL)
8994 {
8995 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
8996 breakpoint address. */
8997 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
8998 {
8999 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9000 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9001 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9002 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9003 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9004 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9005 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9006
9007 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9008
9009 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9010 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9011 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9012 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9013 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9014 sal.pc = pc;
9015 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9016
9017 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9018 lsal.sals = {sal};
9019 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9020
9021 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9022 return;
9023 }
9024 else
9025 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9026 }
9027 }
9028
9029 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9030 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9031 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9032 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9033
9034 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9035 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9036 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9037 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9038 {
9039 const char *spec = NULL;
9040
9041 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9042 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9043
9044 if (!cursal.symtab
9045 || (spec != NULL
9046 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9047 && spec[1] != '['))
9048 {
9049 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9050 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9051 get_last_displayed_line (),
9052 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9053 return;
9054 }
9055 }
9056
9057 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9058 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9059 }
9060
9061
9062 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9063 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9064
9065 static void
9066 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9067 {
9068 for (auto &sal : sals)
9069 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9070 }
9071
9072 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9073 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9074 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9075 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9076 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9077 it, etc. */
9078
9079 static void
9080 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9081 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9082 {
9083 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9084 {
9085 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9086
9087 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9088 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9089 associated with SAL. */
9090 if (sarch == NULL)
9091 sarch = gdbarch;
9092 std::string msg;
9093 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9094 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9095 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9096 }
9097 }
9098
9099 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9100 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9101 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9102 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9103 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9104 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9105
9106 static void
9107 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9108 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9109 char **rest)
9110 {
9111 *cond_string = NULL;
9112 *thread = -1;
9113 *task = 0;
9114 *rest = NULL;
9115
9116 while (tok && *tok)
9117 {
9118 const char *end_tok;
9119 int toklen;
9120 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9121 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9122
9123 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9124
9125 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9126 {
9127 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9128 return;
9129 }
9130
9131 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9132
9133 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9134
9135 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9136 {
9137 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9138 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9139 cond_end = tok;
9140 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9141 }
9142 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9143 {
9144 const char *tmptok;
9145 struct thread_info *thr;
9146
9147 tok = end_tok + 1;
9148 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9149 if (tok == tmptok)
9150 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9151 *thread = thr->global_num;
9152 tok = tmptok;
9153 }
9154 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9155 {
9156 char *tmptok;
9157
9158 tok = end_tok + 1;
9159 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9160 if (tok == tmptok)
9161 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9162 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9163 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9164 tok = tmptok;
9165 }
9166 else if (rest)
9167 {
9168 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9169 return;
9170 }
9171 else
9172 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9173 }
9174 }
9175
9176 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9177
9178 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9179 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9180 {
9181 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9182 const char *endp;
9183
9184 p = skip_spaces (p);
9185
9186 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9187
9188 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9189
9190 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9191 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9192 if (markers.empty ())
9193 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9194 marker_str.c_str ());
9195
9196 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9197 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9198
9199 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9200 {
9201 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9202 sal.pc = marker.address;
9203 sals.push_back (sal);
9204 }
9205
9206 *arg_p = endp;
9207 return sals;
9208 }
9209
9210 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9211
9212 int
9213 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9214 const struct event_location *location,
9215 const char *cond_string,
9216 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9217 int parse_extra,
9218 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9219 int ignore_count,
9220 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9221 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9222 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9223 unsigned flags)
9224 {
9225 struct linespec_result canonical;
9226 int pending = 0;
9227 int task = 0;
9228 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9229
9230 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9231
9232 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9233 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9234 extra_string = NULL;
9235
9236 try
9237 {
9238 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9239 }
9240 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9241 {
9242 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9243 value. */
9244 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9245 {
9246 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9247 error. */
9248
9249 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9250 throw;
9251
9252 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9253
9254 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9255 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9256 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9257 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9258 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9259 return 0;
9260
9261 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9262 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9263 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9264 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9265 pending = 1;
9266 }
9267 else
9268 throw;
9269 }
9270
9271 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9272 return 0;
9273
9274 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9275 are ok for the target. */
9276 if (!pending)
9277 {
9278 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9279 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9280 }
9281
9282 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9283 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9284 {
9285 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9286 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9287 }
9288
9289 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9290 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9291 breakpoint. */
9292 if (!pending)
9293 {
9294 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9295 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9296
9297 if (parse_extra)
9298 {
9299 char *rest;
9300 char *cond;
9301
9302 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9303
9304 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9305 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9306 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9307 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9308
9309 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9310 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9311 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9312 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9313 }
9314 else
9315 {
9316 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9317 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9318 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9319
9320 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9321 if (cond_string)
9322 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9323 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9324 if (extra_string)
9325 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9326 }
9327
9328 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9329 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9330 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9331 type_wanted,
9332 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9333 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9334 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9335 }
9336 else
9337 {
9338 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9339
9340 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9341 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9342
9343 if (parse_extra)
9344 b->cond_string = NULL;
9345 else
9346 {
9347 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9348 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9349 b->thread = thread;
9350 }
9351
9352 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9353 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9354 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9355 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9356 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9357 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9358 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9359 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9360 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9361
9362 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9363 }
9364
9365 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9366 {
9367 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9368 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9369 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9370 }
9371
9372 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9373
9374 return 1;
9375 }
9376
9377 /* Set a breakpoint.
9378 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9379 condition, and thread.
9380 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9381 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9382 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9383
9384 static void
9385 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9386 {
9387 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9388 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9389 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9390 : bp_breakpoint);
9391 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9392
9393 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9394
9395 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9396 if (location != NULL
9397 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9398 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9399 else
9400 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9401
9402 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9403 location.get (),
9404 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9405 tempflag, type_wanted,
9406 0 /* Ignore count */,
9407 pending_break_support,
9408 ops,
9409 from_tty,
9410 1 /* enabled */,
9411 0 /* internal */,
9412 0);
9413 }
9414
9415 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9416
9417 void
9418 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9419 {
9420 CORE_ADDR pc;
9421
9422 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9423 {
9424 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9425 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9426 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9427 sal->pc = pc;
9428
9429 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9430 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9431 if (sal->explicit_line)
9432 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9433 }
9434
9435 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9436 {
9437 const struct blockvector *bv;
9438 const struct block *b;
9439 struct symbol *sym;
9440
9441 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9442 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9443 if (bv != NULL)
9444 {
9445 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9446 if (sym != NULL)
9447 {
9448 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9449 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9450 sym);
9451 }
9452 else
9453 {
9454 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9455 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9456 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9457 happen in assembly source). */
9458
9459 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9460 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9461
9462 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9463 if (msym.minsym)
9464 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9465 }
9466 }
9467 }
9468 }
9469
9470 void
9471 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9472 {
9473 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9474 }
9475
9476 void
9477 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9478 {
9479 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9480 }
9481
9482 static void
9483 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9484 {
9485 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9486 }
9487
9488 static void
9489 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9490 {
9491 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9492 }
9493
9494 static void
9495 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9496 {
9497 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9498 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9499 stop at <line>\n"));
9500 }
9501
9502 static void
9503 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9504 {
9505 int badInput = 0;
9506
9507 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9508 badInput = 1;
9509 else if (*arg != '*')
9510 {
9511 const char *argptr = arg;
9512 int hasColon = 0;
9513
9514 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9515 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9516 function/method name. */
9517 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9518 {
9519 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9520 argptr++;
9521 }
9522
9523 if (hasColon)
9524 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9525 else
9526 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9527 }
9528
9529 if (badInput)
9530 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9531 else
9532 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9533 }
9534
9535 static void
9536 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9537 {
9538 int badInput = 0;
9539
9540 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9541 badInput = 1;
9542 else
9543 {
9544 const char *argptr = arg;
9545 int hasColon = 0;
9546
9547 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9548 it is probably a line number. */
9549 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9550 {
9551 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9552 argptr++;
9553 }
9554
9555 if (hasColon)
9556 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9557 else
9558 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9559 }
9560
9561 if (badInput)
9562 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9563 else
9564 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9565 }
9566
9567 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9568 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9569 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9570 line. */
9571
9572 static void
9573 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9574 {
9575 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9576
9577 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9578 the next character must be ','. */
9579 if (arg != NULL)
9580 {
9581 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9582 error (_("Format string required"));
9583 else
9584 {
9585 /* Skip the comma. */
9586 ++arg;
9587 }
9588 }
9589
9590 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9591 location.get (),
9592 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9593 0, bp_dprintf,
9594 0 /* Ignore count */,
9595 pending_break_support,
9596 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9597 from_tty,
9598 1 /* enabled */,
9599 0 /* internal */,
9600 0);
9601 }
9602
9603 static void
9604 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9605 {
9606 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9607 }
9608
9609 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9610 ranged breakpoints. */
9611
9612 static int
9613 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9614 const address_space *aspace,
9615 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9616 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9617 {
9618 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9619 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9620 return 0;
9621
9622 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9623 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9624 }
9625
9626 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9627 ranged breakpoints. */
9628
9629 static int
9630 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9631 {
9632 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9633 }
9634
9635 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9636 ranged breakpoints. */
9637
9638 static enum print_stop_action
9639 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9640 {
9641 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9642 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9643 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9644
9645 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9646
9647 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9648 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9649
9650 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9651
9652 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9653
9654 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9655 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9656 else
9657 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9658 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9659 {
9660 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9661 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9662 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9663 }
9664 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9665 uiout->text (", ");
9666
9667 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9668 }
9669
9670 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9671 ranged breakpoints. */
9672
9673 static void
9674 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9675 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9676 {
9677 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9678 struct value_print_options opts;
9679 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9680
9681 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9682 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9683
9684 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9685
9686 if (opts.addressprint)
9687 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9688 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9689 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9690 annotate_field (5);
9691 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9692 *last_loc = bl;
9693 }
9694
9695 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9696 ranged breakpoints. */
9697
9698 static void
9699 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9700 struct ui_out *uiout)
9701 {
9702 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9703 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9704 string_file stb;
9705
9706 gdb_assert (bl);
9707
9708 address_start = bl->address;
9709 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9710
9711 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9712 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9713 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9714 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9715 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9716 uiout->text ("\n");
9717 }
9718
9719 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9720 ranged breakpoints. */
9721
9722 static void
9723 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9724 {
9725 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9726 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9727
9728 gdb_assert (bl);
9729 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9730
9731 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9732 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9733 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9734 }
9735
9736 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9737 ranged breakpoints. */
9738
9739 static void
9740 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9741 {
9742 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9743 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9744 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9745 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9746 }
9747
9748 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9749
9750 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9751
9752 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9753 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9754 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9755 last instruction of the given line. */
9756
9757 static CORE_ADDR
9758 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9759 {
9760 CORE_ADDR end;
9761
9762 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9763 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9764 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9765 end = sal.pc;
9766 else
9767 {
9768 int ret;
9769 CORE_ADDR start;
9770
9771 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9772 if (!ret)
9773 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9774
9775 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9776 end--;
9777 }
9778
9779 return end;
9780 }
9781
9782 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9783
9784 static void
9785 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9786 {
9787 const char *arg_start;
9788 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9789 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9790 CORE_ADDR end;
9791 struct breakpoint *b;
9792
9793 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9794 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9795 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9796
9797 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9798 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9799 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9800 bp_count, 0);
9801 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9802 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9803
9804 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9805 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9806 error(_("No address range specified."));
9807
9808 arg_start = arg;
9809 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9810 current_language);
9811 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9812
9813 if (arg[0] != ',')
9814 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9815 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9816 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9817
9818 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9819
9820 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9821 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9822 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9823
9824 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9825 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9826
9827 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9828 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9829
9830 /* Parse the end location. */
9831
9832 arg_start = arg;
9833
9834 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9835 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9836 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9837 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9838 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9839 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9840 current_language);
9841 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9842 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9843 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9844
9845 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9846 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9847
9848 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9849 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9850 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9851 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9852
9853 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9854
9855 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9856 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9857 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9858
9859 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9860 if (length < 0)
9861 /* Length overflowed. */
9862 error (_("Address range too large."));
9863 else if (length == 1)
9864 {
9865 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9866 the `hbreak' command. */
9867 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9868
9869 return;
9870 }
9871
9872 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9873 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9874 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9875 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9876 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9877 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9878 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9879 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9880 b->loc->length = length;
9881
9882 mention (b);
9883 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9884 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9885 }
9886
9887 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9888 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9889 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9890 zero. */
9891
9892 static int
9893 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9894 {
9895 int i = exp->nelts;
9896
9897 while (i > 0)
9898 {
9899 int oplenp, argsp;
9900
9901 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9902 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9903 i -= oplenp;
9904
9905 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9906 {
9907 case BINOP_ADD:
9908 case BINOP_SUB:
9909 case BINOP_MUL:
9910 case BINOP_DIV:
9911 case BINOP_REM:
9912 case BINOP_MOD:
9913 case BINOP_LSH:
9914 case BINOP_RSH:
9915 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9916 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9917 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9918 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9919 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9920 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9921 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9922 case BINOP_LESS:
9923 case BINOP_GTR:
9924 case BINOP_LEQ:
9925 case BINOP_GEQ:
9926 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9927 case BINOP_COMMA:
9928 case BINOP_EXP:
9929 case BINOP_MIN:
9930 case BINOP_MAX:
9931 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9932 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9933 case TERNOP_COND:
9934 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9935
9936 case OP_LONG:
9937 case OP_FLOAT:
9938 case OP_LAST:
9939 case OP_COMPLEX:
9940 case OP_STRING:
9941 case OP_ARRAY:
9942 case OP_TYPE:
9943 case OP_TYPEOF:
9944 case OP_DECLTYPE:
9945 case OP_TYPEID:
9946 case OP_NAME:
9947 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9948
9949 case UNOP_NEG:
9950 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9951 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9952 case UNOP_ADDR:
9953 case UNOP_HIGH:
9954 case UNOP_CAST:
9955
9956 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
9957 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
9958 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
9959 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
9960 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
9961 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
9962 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
9963
9964 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
9965 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
9966 ADDR is. */
9967 break;
9968
9969 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9970 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
9971
9972 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
9973 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
9974 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
9975 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
9976
9977 We also have to check for function symbols because they
9978 are always constant. */
9979 {
9980 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
9981
9982 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
9983 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
9984 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
9985 return 0;
9986 break;
9987 }
9988
9989 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
9990 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
9991 then it is not a constant. */
9992 default:
9993 return 0;
9994 }
9995 }
9996
9997 return 1;
9998 }
9999
10000 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10001
10002 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10003 {
10004 xfree (this->exp_string);
10005 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10006 }
10007
10008 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10009
10010 static void
10011 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10012 {
10013 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10014
10015 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10016 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10017
10018 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10019 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10020 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10021 are loaded and unloaded.
10022
10023 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10024 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10025 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10026 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10027 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10028 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10029
10030 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10031 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10032 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10033 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10034
10035 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10036 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10037
10038 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10039 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10040 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10041 }
10042
10043 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10044
10045 static int
10046 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10047 {
10048 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10049 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10050
10051 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10052 w->cond_exp.get ());
10053 }
10054
10055 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10056
10057 static int
10058 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10059 {
10060 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10061 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10062
10063 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10064 w->cond_exp.get ());
10065 }
10066
10067 static int
10068 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10069 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10070 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10071 {
10072 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10073 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10074
10075 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10076 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10077 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10078 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10079 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10080 (did not match the data address). */
10081 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10082 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10083 return 0;
10084
10085 return 1;
10086 }
10087
10088 static void
10089 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10090 {
10091 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10092
10093 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10094 }
10095
10096 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10097 hardware watchpoints. */
10098
10099 static int
10100 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10101 {
10102 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10103 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10104
10105 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10106 }
10107
10108 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10109 hardware watchpoints. */
10110
10111 static int
10112 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10113 {
10114 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10115 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10116 }
10117
10118 static enum print_stop_action
10119 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10120 {
10121 struct breakpoint *b;
10122 enum print_stop_action result;
10123 struct watchpoint *w;
10124 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10125
10126 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10127
10128 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10129 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10130
10131 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10132 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10133
10134 string_file stb;
10135
10136 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10137 switch (b->type)
10138 {
10139 case bp_watchpoint:
10140 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10141 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10142 uiout->field_string
10143 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10144 mention (b);
10145 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10146 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10147 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10148 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10149 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10150 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10151 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10152 uiout->text ("\n");
10153 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10154 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10155 break;
10156
10157 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10158 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10159 uiout->field_string
10160 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10161 mention (b);
10162 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10163 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10164 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10165 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10166 uiout->text ("\n");
10167 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10168 break;
10169
10170 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10171 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10172 {
10173 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10174 uiout->field_string
10175 ("reason",
10176 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10177 mention (b);
10178 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10179 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10180 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10181 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10182 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10183 }
10184 else
10185 {
10186 mention (b);
10187 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10188 uiout->field_string
10189 ("reason",
10190 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10191 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10192 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10193 }
10194 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10195 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10196 uiout->text ("\n");
10197 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10198 break;
10199 default:
10200 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10201 }
10202
10203 return result;
10204 }
10205
10206 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10207 watchpoints. */
10208
10209 static void
10210 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10211 {
10212 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10213 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10214 const char *tuple_name;
10215
10216 switch (b->type)
10217 {
10218 case bp_watchpoint:
10219 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10220 tuple_name = "wpt";
10221 break;
10222 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10223 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10224 tuple_name = "wpt";
10225 break;
10226 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10227 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10228 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10229 break;
10230 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10231 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10232 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10233 break;
10234 default:
10235 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10236 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10237 }
10238
10239 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10240 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10241 uiout->text (": ");
10242 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10243 }
10244
10245 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10246 watchpoints. */
10247
10248 static void
10249 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10250 {
10251 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10252
10253 switch (b->type)
10254 {
10255 case bp_watchpoint:
10256 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10257 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10258 break;
10259 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10260 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10261 break;
10262 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10263 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10264 break;
10265 default:
10266 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10267 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10268 }
10269
10270 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10271 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10272 }
10273
10274 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10275 watchpoints. */
10276
10277 static int
10278 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10279 {
10280 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10281 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10282 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10283 return 0;
10284
10285 return 1;
10286 }
10287
10288 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10289
10290 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10291
10292 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10293 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10294
10295 static int
10296 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10297 {
10298 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10299
10300 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10301 bl->watchpoint_type);
10302 }
10303
10304 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10305 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10306
10307 static int
10308 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10309 {
10310 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10311
10312 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10313 bl->watchpoint_type);
10314 }
10315
10316 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10317 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10318
10319 static int
10320 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10321 {
10322 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10323
10324 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10325 }
10326
10327 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10328 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10329
10330 static int
10331 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10332 {
10333 return 0;
10334 }
10335
10336 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10337 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10338
10339 static enum print_stop_action
10340 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10341 {
10342 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10343 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10344
10345 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10346 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10347
10348 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10349 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10350
10351 switch (b->type)
10352 {
10353 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10354 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10355 uiout->field_string
10356 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10357 break;
10358
10359 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10360 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10361 uiout->field_string
10362 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10363 break;
10364
10365 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10366 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10367 uiout->field_string
10368 ("reason",
10369 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10370 break;
10371 default:
10372 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10373 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10374 }
10375
10376 mention (b);
10377 uiout->text (_("\n\
10378 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10379 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10380 uiout->text ("\n");
10381
10382 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10383 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10384 }
10385
10386 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10387 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10388
10389 static void
10390 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10391 struct ui_out *uiout)
10392 {
10393 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10394
10395 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10396 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10397
10398 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10399 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10400 uiout->text ("\n");
10401 }
10402
10403 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10404 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10405
10406 static void
10407 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10408 {
10409 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10410 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10411 const char *tuple_name;
10412
10413 switch (b->type)
10414 {
10415 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10416 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10417 tuple_name = "wpt";
10418 break;
10419 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10420 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10421 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10422 break;
10423 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10424 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10425 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10426 break;
10427 default:
10428 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10429 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10430 }
10431
10432 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10433 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10434 uiout->text (": ");
10435 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10436 }
10437
10438 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10439 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10440
10441 static void
10442 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10443 {
10444 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10445 char tmp[40];
10446
10447 switch (b->type)
10448 {
10449 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10450 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10451 break;
10452 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10453 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10454 break;
10455 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10456 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10457 break;
10458 default:
10459 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10460 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10461 }
10462
10463 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10464 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10465 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10466 }
10467
10468 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10469
10470 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10471
10472 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10473
10474 static int
10475 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10476 {
10477 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10478 }
10479
10480 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10481 hw_read: watch read,
10482 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10483 static void
10484 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10485 int just_location, int internal)
10486 {
10487 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10488 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10489 struct value *result;
10490 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10491 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10492 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10493 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10494 int toklen = -1;
10495 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10496 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10497 enum bptype bp_type;
10498 int thread = -1;
10499 int pc = 0;
10500 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10501 the hardware watchpoint. */
10502 int use_mask = 0;
10503 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10504
10505 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10506 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10507 {
10508 const char *value_start;
10509
10510 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10511
10512 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10513 of the arguments string. */
10514 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10515 {
10516 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10517 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10518 tok--;
10519
10520 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10521 This is the value of the parameter. */
10522 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10523 tok--;
10524 value_start = tok + 1;
10525
10526 /* Skip whitespace. */
10527 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10528 tok--;
10529
10530 end_tok = tok;
10531
10532 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10533 This is the parameter itself. */
10534 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10535 tok--;
10536 tok++;
10537 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10538
10539 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10540 {
10541 struct thread_info *thr;
10542 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10543 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10544 only in a specific thread. */
10545 const char *endp;
10546
10547 if (thread != -1)
10548 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10549
10550 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10551 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10552
10553 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10554 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10555 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10556
10557 thread = thr->global_num;
10558 }
10559 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10560 {
10561 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10562 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10563 facility. */
10564 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10565
10566 if (use_mask)
10567 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10568
10569 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10570
10571 mark = value_mark ();
10572 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10573 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10574 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10575 }
10576 else
10577 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10578 break;
10579
10580 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10581 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10582 exp_end = tok;
10583 }
10584 }
10585 else
10586 exp_end = arg;
10587
10588 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10589 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10590 ARG. */
10591 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10592 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10593 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
10594 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
10595 exp_end = arg;
10596 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10597 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10598 prettier. */
10599 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10600 --exp_end;
10601
10602 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10603 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10604 {
10605 int len;
10606
10607 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10608 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10609 len--;
10610 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10611 }
10612
10613 exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
10614 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10615 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10616 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10617 just_location);
10618
10619 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10620 {
10621 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10622 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10623 }
10624
10625 value_ref_ptr val;
10626 if (just_location)
10627 {
10628 int ret;
10629
10630 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10631 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10632 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10633
10634 if (use_mask)
10635 {
10636 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10637 mask);
10638 if (ret == -1)
10639 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10640 else if (ret == -2)
10641 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10642 }
10643 }
10644 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10645 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10646
10647 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10648 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10649
10650 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10651 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10652 {
10653 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10654 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
10655 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
10656
10657 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10658 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10659 cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
10660
10661 cond_end = tok;
10662 }
10663 if (*tok)
10664 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10665
10666 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10667
10668 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10669 'wp_frame'. */
10670 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10671
10672 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10673 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10674 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10675 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10676 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10677 {
10678 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10679
10680 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10681 {
10682 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10683 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10684
10685 scope_breakpoint
10686 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10687 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10688 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10689
10690 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10691 wp_frame = NULL;
10692
10693 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10694
10695 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10696 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10697
10698 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10699 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10700
10701 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10702 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10703 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10704 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10705 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10706 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10707 scope_breakpoint->type);
10708 }
10709 }
10710
10711 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10712 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10713 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10714 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10715
10716 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10717 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10718 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10719 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10720 else
10721 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10722
10723 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10724
10725 if (use_mask)
10726 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10727 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10728 else
10729 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10730 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10731 w->thread = thread;
10732 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10733 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10734 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10735 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10736 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10737 if (just_location)
10738 {
10739 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10740 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10741
10742 w->exp_string_reparse
10743 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10744
10745 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10746 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10747 }
10748 else
10749 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10750
10751 if (use_mask)
10752 {
10753 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10754 }
10755 else
10756 {
10757 w->val = val;
10758 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10759 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10760 w->val_valid = 1;
10761 }
10762
10763 if (cond_start)
10764 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10765 else
10766 w->cond_string = 0;
10767
10768 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10769 {
10770 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10771 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10772 }
10773 else
10774 {
10775 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10776 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10777 }
10778
10779 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10780 {
10781 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10782 need to act on them together. */
10783 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10784 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10785 }
10786
10787 if (!just_location)
10788 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10789
10790 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10791 that should be inserted. */
10792 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10793
10794 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10795 }
10796
10797 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10798 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10799
10800 static int
10801 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10802 {
10803 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10804
10805 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10806 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10807 return 0;
10808
10809 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10810 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10811
10812 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10813 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10814 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10815 hardware watchpoint.
10816
10817 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10818 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10819 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10820 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10821 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10822 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10823 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10824 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10825 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10826
10827 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10828 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10829 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10830 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10831 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10832 {
10833 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10834
10835 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10836 {
10837 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10838 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10839 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10840 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10841 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10842 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10843 ;
10844 else
10845 {
10846 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10847 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10848 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10849
10850 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10851 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10852 middle of some value chain. */
10853 if (v == head
10854 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10855 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10856 {
10857 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10858 int len;
10859 int num_regs;
10860
10861 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10862 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10863 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10864
10865 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10866 if (!num_regs)
10867 return 0;
10868 else
10869 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10870 }
10871 }
10872 }
10873 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10874 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10875 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10876 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10877 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10878 }
10879
10880 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10881 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10882 return found_memory_cnt;
10883 }
10884
10885 void
10886 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10887 {
10888 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10889 }
10890
10891 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10892 calls watch_command_1. */
10893
10894 static void
10895 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10896 {
10897 int just_location = 0;
10898
10899 if (arg
10900 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10901 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10902 {
10903 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10904 just_location = 1;
10905 }
10906
10907 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10908 }
10909
10910 static void
10911 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10912 {
10913 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10914 }
10915
10916 void
10917 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10918 {
10919 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10920 }
10921
10922 static void
10923 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10924 {
10925 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10926 }
10927
10928 void
10929 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10930 {
10931 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10932 }
10933
10934 static void
10935 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10936 {
10937 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10938 }
10939 \f
10940
10941 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10942 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10943 breakpoints. */
10944
10945 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
10946 {
10947 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
10948 int thread;
10949
10950 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10951 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
10952
10953 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
10954 NULL. */
10955 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
10956
10957 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
10958 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
10959 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
10960 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
10961 thread (thread),
10962 location_breakpoint (std::move (location_breakpoint)),
10963 caller_breakpoint (std::move (caller_breakpoint))
10964 {
10965 }
10966
10967 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10968 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
10969 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
10970 };
10971
10972 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
10973 until(location)/advance commands. */
10974
10975 bool
10976 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
10977 {
10978 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10979 location_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL
10980 || (caller_breakpoint != NULL
10981 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
10982 caller_breakpoint.get ()) != NULL))
10983 set_finished ();
10984
10985 return true;
10986 }
10987
10988 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
10989 until(location)/advance commands. */
10990
10991 void
10992 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
10993 {
10994 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
10995 location_breakpoint.reset ();
10996 caller_breakpoint.reset ();
10997 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
10998 }
10999
11000 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11001 until(location)/advance commands. */
11002
11003 enum async_reply_reason
11004 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
11005 {
11006 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11007 }
11008
11009 void
11010 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11011 {
11012 struct frame_info *frame;
11013 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11014 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11015 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11016 int thread;
11017 struct thread_info *tp;
11018
11019 clear_proceed_status (0);
11020
11021 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11022 this function. */
11023
11024 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11025
11026 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11027 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11028 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11029 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11030 get_last_displayed_line ())
11031 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11032 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11033
11034 if (sals.size () != 1)
11035 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11036
11037 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11038
11039 if (*arg)
11040 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11041
11042 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11043
11044 tp = inferior_thread ();
11045 thread = tp->global_num;
11046
11047 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11048 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11049 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11050 that. */
11051
11052 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11053 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11054 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11055 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11056
11057 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11058 one. */
11059
11060 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11061
11062 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
11063
11064 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11065 {
11066 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11067 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11068
11069 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11070 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11071 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11072 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11073 sal2,
11074 caller_frame_id,
11075 bp_until);
11076
11077 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11078 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
11079 }
11080
11081 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11082 frame = NULL;
11083
11084 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11085 if (anywhere)
11086 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11087 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11088 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11089 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11090 else
11091 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11092 only at the very same frame. */
11093 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11094 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11095
11096 tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11097 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11098 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11099
11100 if (lj_deleter)
11101 lj_deleter->release ();
11102
11103 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11104 }
11105
11106 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11107 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11108
11109 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11110 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11111 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11112 if clause in the arg string. */
11113
11114 const char *
11115 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11116 {
11117 const char *cond_string;
11118
11119 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11120 return NULL;
11121
11122 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11123 (*arg) += 2;
11124
11125 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11126 condition string. */
11127 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11128 cond_string = *arg;
11129
11130 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11131 string. */
11132 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11133
11134 return cond_string;
11135 }
11136
11137 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11138 process start/exit, etc. */
11139
11140 typedef enum
11141 {
11142 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11143 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11144 }
11145 catch_fork_kind;
11146
11147 static void
11148 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11149 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11150 {
11151 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11152 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11153 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11154 int tempflag;
11155
11156 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11157 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11158 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11159
11160 if (!arg)
11161 arg = "";
11162 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11163
11164 /* The allowed syntax is:
11165 catch [v]fork
11166 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11167
11168 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11169 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11170
11171 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11172 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11173
11174 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11175 and enable reporting of such events. */
11176 switch (fork_kind)
11177 {
11178 case catch_fork_temporary:
11179 case catch_fork_permanent:
11180 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11181 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11182 break;
11183 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11184 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11185 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11186 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11187 break;
11188 default:
11189 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11190 break;
11191 }
11192 }
11193
11194 static void
11195 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11196 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11197 {
11198 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11199 int tempflag;
11200 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11201
11202 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11203
11204 if (!arg)
11205 arg = "";
11206 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11207
11208 /* The allowed syntax is:
11209 catch exec
11210 catch exec if <cond>
11211
11212 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11213 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11214
11215 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11216 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11217
11218 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11219 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11220 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11221 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11222
11223 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11224 }
11225
11226 void
11227 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11228 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11229 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11230 const char *addr_string,
11231 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11232 int tempflag,
11233 int enabled,
11234 int from_tty)
11235 {
11236 if (from_tty)
11237 {
11238 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11239 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11240 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11241
11242 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11243 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11244 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11245 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11246 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11247 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11248 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11249 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11250 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11251 enough for now, though. */
11252 }
11253
11254 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11255
11256 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11257 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11258 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11259 language_def (language_ada));
11260 b->language = language_ada;
11261 }
11262
11263 static void
11264 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11265 {
11266 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11267 }
11268 \f
11269
11270 static void
11271 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11272 {
11273 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11274 }
11275
11276 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11277
11278 static int
11279 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11280 {
11281 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11282 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11283
11284 if (a->number < b->number)
11285 return -1;
11286 else if (a->number > b->number)
11287 return 1;
11288
11289 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11290 the number 0. */
11291 if (ua < ub)
11292 return -1;
11293 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11294 }
11295
11296 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11297
11298 static void
11299 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11300 {
11301 struct breakpoint *b;
11302 int default_match;
11303
11304 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11305 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11306 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11307 if (arg)
11308 {
11309 decoded_sals
11310 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11311 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11312 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11313 default_match = 0;
11314 sals = decoded_sals;
11315 }
11316 else
11317 {
11318 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11319 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11320 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11321 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11322 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11323 error (_("No source file specified."));
11324
11325 default_match = 1;
11326 sals = last_sal;
11327 }
11328
11329 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11330 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11331 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11332 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11333
11334 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11335 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11336 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11337 due to optimization, all in one block.
11338
11339 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11340 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11341 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11342 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11343 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11344 to support that. */
11345
11346 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11347 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11348 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11349 breakpoint. */
11350
11351 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11352 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11353 {
11354 const char *sal_fullname;
11355
11356 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11357 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11358 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11359 or at default pc.
11360
11361 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11362
11363 0 1 pc
11364 1 1 pc _and_ line
11365 0 0 line
11366 1 0 <can't happen> */
11367
11368 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11369 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11370
11371 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11372 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11373 {
11374 int match = 0;
11375 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11376 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11377 {
11378 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11379 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11380 {
11381 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11382 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11383 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11384 && sal.pc
11385 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11386 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11387 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11388 || loc->section == sal.section));
11389 int line_match = 0;
11390
11391 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11392 && loc->symtab != NULL
11393 && sal_fullname != NULL
11394 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11395 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11396 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11397 sal_fullname) == 0)
11398 line_match = 1;
11399
11400 if (pc_match || line_match)
11401 {
11402 match = 1;
11403 break;
11404 }
11405 }
11406 }
11407
11408 if (match)
11409 found.push_back (b);
11410 }
11411 }
11412
11413 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11414 if (found.empty ())
11415 {
11416 if (arg)
11417 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11418 else
11419 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11420 }
11421
11422 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11423 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11424 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11425 {
11426 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11427 });
11428 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11429 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11430 {
11431 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11432 }),
11433 found.end ());
11434
11435 if (found.size () > 1)
11436 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11437 if (from_tty)
11438 {
11439 if (found.size () == 1)
11440 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11441 else
11442 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11443 }
11444
11445 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11446 {
11447 if (from_tty)
11448 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11449 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11450 }
11451 if (from_tty)
11452 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11453 }
11454 \f
11455 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11456 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11457 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11458
11459 void
11460 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11461 {
11462 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11463
11464 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11465 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11466 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11467 && bs->stop)
11468 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11469
11470 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11471 {
11472 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11473 delete_breakpoint (b);
11474 }
11475 }
11476
11477 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11478 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11479 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11480 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11481 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11482 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11483
11484 static int
11485 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11486 {
11487 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11488 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11489
11490 if (a->address != b->address)
11491 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11492
11493 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11494 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11495 grouped. */
11496
11497 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11498 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11499 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11500
11501 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11502 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11503 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11504
11505 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11506 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11507 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11508
11509 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11510 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11511 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11512
11513 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11514 }
11515
11516 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11517 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11518 content of the bp_locations array. */
11519
11520 static void
11521 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11522 {
11523 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11524
11525 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11526 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11527
11528 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11529 {
11530 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11531
11532 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11533 continue;
11534
11535 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11536 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11537
11538 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11539 addr = bl->address - start;
11540 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11541 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11542
11543 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11544
11545 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11546 addr = end - bl->address;
11547 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11548 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11549 }
11550 }
11551
11552 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11553
11554 static void
11555 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11556 {
11557 struct breakpoint *b;
11558 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11559
11560 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11561
11562 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11563 {
11564 struct bp_location *bl;
11565 struct tracepoint *t;
11566 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11567
11568 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11569 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11570 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11571 continue;
11572
11573 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11574 {
11575 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11576 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11577 else
11578 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11579 }
11580
11581 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11582 break;
11583
11584 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11585 {
11586 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11587 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11588 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11589 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11590 continue;
11591
11592 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11593
11594 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11595
11596 bl->inserted = 1;
11597 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11598 }
11599 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11600 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11601 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11602 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11603 }
11604 }
11605
11606 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11607
11608 static void
11609 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11610 {
11611 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11612 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11613 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11614 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11615
11616 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11617 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11618 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11619 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11620 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11621
11622 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11623 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11624 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11625 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11626 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11627 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11628 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11629 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11630 }
11631
11632 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11633 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11634 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11635 the target. */
11636
11637 static void
11638 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11639 {
11640 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11641 struct bp_location *loc;
11642 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11643 int pspace_num;
11644
11645 address = bl->address;
11646 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11647
11648 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11649 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11650 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11651 side. */
11652 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11653 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11654 return;
11655
11656 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11657 the same program space as the location
11658 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11659 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11660 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11661 {
11662 loc = *loc2p;
11663
11664 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11665 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11666 continue;
11667
11668 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11669 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11670 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11671 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11672 that have already been marked. */
11673 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11674
11675 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11676 it later on. */
11677 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11678 }
11679 }
11680 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11681 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11682 locations are duplicate of which.
11683
11684 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11685 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11686 info. */
11687
11688 static void
11689 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11690 {
11691 struct breakpoint *b;
11692 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11693 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11694 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11695 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11696 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11697
11698 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11699 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11700 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11701 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11702 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11703 once. */
11704 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11705 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11706 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11707 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11708
11709 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11710 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11711 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11712 unsigned old_locations_count;
11713 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11714
11715 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11716 bp_locations = NULL;
11717 bp_locations_count = 0;
11718
11719 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11720 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11721 bp_locations_count++;
11722
11723 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11724 locp = bp_locations;
11725 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11726 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11727 *locp++ = loc;
11728 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11729 bp_locations_compare);
11730
11731 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11732
11733 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11734 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11735 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11736 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11737 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11738 location.
11739
11740 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11741 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11742
11743 locp = bp_locations;
11744 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11745 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11746 old_locp++)
11747 {
11748 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11749 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11750
11751 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11752 not, we have to free it. */
11753 int found_object = 0;
11754 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11755 int keep_in_target = 0;
11756 int removed = 0;
11757
11758 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11759 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11760 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11761 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11762 locp++;
11763
11764 for (loc2p = locp;
11765 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11766 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11767 loc2p++)
11768 {
11769 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11770 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11771 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11772 place there. */
11773 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11774 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11775 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11776 {
11777 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11778 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11779 }
11780
11781 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11782 found_object = 1;
11783 }
11784
11785 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11786 have to go through updates again. */
11787 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11788
11789 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11790 if (!found_object)
11791 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11792
11793 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11794 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11795 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11796 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11797 at certain location is not inserted. */
11798
11799 if (old_loc->inserted)
11800 {
11801 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11802 it. */
11803
11804 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11805 {
11806 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11807 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11808 keep_in_target = 1;
11809 }
11810 else
11811 {
11812 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11813 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11814 remove its target-side condition. */
11815
11816 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11817 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11818 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11819 this one from the target. */
11820
11821 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11822 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11823 {
11824 for (loc2p = locp;
11825 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11826 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11827 loc2p++)
11828 {
11829 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11830
11831 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11832 {
11833 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11834 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11835 supported, but the latter are. */
11836 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11837 {
11838 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11839 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11840 }
11841
11842 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11843 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11844 unduplicated. */
11845 if (loc2 != old_loc
11846 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11847 {
11848 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11849 keep_in_target = 1;
11850 break;
11851 }
11852 }
11853 }
11854 }
11855 }
11856
11857 if (!keep_in_target)
11858 {
11859 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11860 {
11861 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11862 this location on the global list, and try to
11863 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11864 reason why we will succeed next time.
11865
11866 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11867 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11868 only after calling us. */
11869 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11870 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11871 old_loc->owner->number);
11872 }
11873 removed = 1;
11874 }
11875 }
11876
11877 if (!found_object)
11878 {
11879 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11880 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11881 {
11882 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11883 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11884 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11885 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11886 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11887 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11888 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11889 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11890 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11891 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11892 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11893 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11894 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11895 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11896 SIGTRAP.
11897
11898 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11899 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11900
11901 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11902 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11903 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11904 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11905 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11906 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11907 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11908 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11909 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11910 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11911 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11912 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11913 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11914 thread_count.
11915
11916 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
11917 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
11918 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
11919 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
11920
11921 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
11922 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
11923 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
11924 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
11925 traps we can no longer explain. */
11926
11927 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
11928 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11929
11930 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
11931 }
11932 else
11933 {
11934 old_loc->owner = NULL;
11935 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
11936 }
11937 }
11938 }
11939
11940 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
11941 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
11942 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
11943 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
11944 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
11945 are sorted first for the same address.
11946
11947 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
11948 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
11949
11950 bp_loc_first = NULL;
11951 wp_loc_first = NULL;
11952 awp_loc_first = NULL;
11953 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
11954 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
11955 {
11956 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
11957 non-NULL. */
11958 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
11959 b = loc->owner;
11960
11961 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
11962 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
11963 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
11964 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
11965 `struct bp_location'. */
11966 || is_tracepoint (b))
11967 {
11968 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11969 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11970 continue;
11971 }
11972
11973 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11974 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
11975 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11976 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
11977 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11978 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
11979 else
11980 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
11981
11982 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
11983 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
11984 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
11985 {
11986 *loc_first_p = loc;
11987 loc->duplicate = 0;
11988
11989 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
11990 {
11991 loc->needs_update = 1;
11992 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
11993 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
11994 }
11995 continue;
11996 }
11997
11998
11999 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12000 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12001 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12002 if (loc->inserted)
12003 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12004 loc->duplicate = 1;
12005
12006 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12007 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12008 }
12009
12010 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12011 {
12012 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12013 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12014 else
12015 {
12016 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12017 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12018 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12019 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12020 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12021 "needs_update". */
12022 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12023 }
12024 }
12025
12026 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12027 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12028 }
12029
12030 void
12031 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12032 {
12033 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12034 {
12035 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12036 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12037 {
12038 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12039 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12040 --ix;
12041 }
12042 }
12043 }
12044
12045 static void
12046 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12047 {
12048
12049 try
12050 {
12051 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12052 }
12053 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12054 {
12055 }
12056 }
12057
12058 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12059
12060 static void
12061 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12062 {
12063 bpstat bs;
12064
12065 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12066 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12067 {
12068 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12069 bs->old_val = NULL;
12070 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12071 }
12072 }
12073
12074 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12075 static int
12076 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12077 {
12078 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12079
12080 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12081 return 0;
12082 }
12083
12084 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12085 callbacks. */
12086
12087 static void
12088 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12089 {
12090 struct value_print_options opts;
12091
12092 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12093
12094 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12095 single string. */
12096 if (b->loc == NULL)
12097 {
12098 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12099 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12100 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12101 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12102 {
12103 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12104 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12105 }
12106 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12107 {
12108 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12109 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12110 b->extra_string);
12111 }
12112 else
12113 {
12114 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12115 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12116 b->extra_string);
12117 }
12118 }
12119 else
12120 {
12121 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12122 {
12123 printf_filtered (" at ");
12124 fputs_styled (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12125 address_style.style (),
12126 gdb_stdout);
12127 }
12128 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12129 {
12130 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12131 more nicely. */
12132 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12133 {
12134 puts_filtered (": file ");
12135 fputs_styled (symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12136 file_name_style.style (),
12137 gdb_stdout);
12138 printf_filtered (", line %d.",
12139 b->loc->line_number);
12140 }
12141 else
12142 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12143 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12144 real situation somewhat. */
12145 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12146 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12147 }
12148
12149 if (b->loc->next)
12150 {
12151 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12152 int n = 0;
12153 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12154 ++n;
12155 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12156 }
12157 }
12158 }
12159
12160 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12161 {
12162 xfree (function_name);
12163 }
12164
12165 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12166
12167 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12168 {
12169 xfree (this->cond_string);
12170 xfree (this->extra_string);
12171 xfree (this->filter);
12172 }
12173
12174 static struct bp_location *
12175 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12176 {
12177 return new bp_location (self);
12178 }
12179
12180 static void
12181 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12182 {
12183 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12184 }
12185
12186 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12187 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12188
12189 static int
12190 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12191 {
12192 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12193 }
12194
12195 static int
12196 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12197 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12198 {
12199 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12200 }
12201
12202 static int
12203 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12204 const address_space *aspace,
12205 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12206 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12207 {
12208 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12209 }
12210
12211 static void
12212 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12213 {
12214 /* Always stop. */
12215 }
12216
12217 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12218 errors. */
12219
12220 static int
12221 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12222 {
12223 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12224 }
12225
12226 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12227 errors. */
12228
12229 static int
12230 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12231 {
12232 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12233 }
12234
12235 static enum print_stop_action
12236 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12237 {
12238 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12239 }
12240
12241 static void
12242 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12243 struct ui_out *uiout)
12244 {
12245 /* nothing */
12246 }
12247
12248 static void
12249 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12250 {
12251 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12252 }
12253
12254 static void
12255 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12256 {
12257 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12258 }
12259
12260 static void
12261 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12262 (const struct event_location *location,
12263 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12264 enum bptype type_wanted)
12265 {
12266 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12267 }
12268
12269 static void
12270 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12271 struct linespec_result *c,
12272 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12273 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12274 enum bptype type_wanted,
12275 enum bpdisp disposition,
12276 int thread,
12277 int task, int ignore_count,
12278 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12279 int from_tty, int enabled,
12280 int internal, unsigned flags)
12281 {
12282 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12283 }
12284
12285 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12286 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12287 const struct event_location *location,
12288 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12289 {
12290 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12291 }
12292
12293 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12294
12295 static int
12296 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12297 {
12298 return 1;
12299 }
12300
12301 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12302
12303 static void
12304 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12305 {
12306 /* Nothing to do. */
12307 }
12308
12309 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12310 {
12311 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12312 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12313 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12314 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12315 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12316 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12317 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12318 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12319 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12320 NULL,
12321 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12322 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12323 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12324 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12325 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12326 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12327 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12328 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12329 };
12330
12331 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12332
12333 static void
12334 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12335 {
12336 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12337 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12338 {
12339 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12340 delete_breakpoint (b);
12341 return;
12342 }
12343
12344 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12345 }
12346
12347 static int
12348 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12349 {
12350 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12351
12352 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12353 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12354
12355 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12356 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12357 else
12358 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12359 }
12360
12361 static int
12362 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12363 {
12364 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12365 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12366 else
12367 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12368 }
12369
12370 static int
12371 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12372 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12373 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12374 {
12375 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12376 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12377 return 0;
12378
12379 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12380 aspace, bp_addr))
12381 return 0;
12382
12383 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12384 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12385 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12386 return 0;
12387
12388 return 1;
12389 }
12390
12391 static int
12392 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12393 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12394 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12395 {
12396 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12397 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12398 {
12399 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12400 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12401 be set at the same address. */
12402 return 0;
12403 }
12404
12405 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12406 }
12407
12408 static int
12409 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12410 {
12411 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12412
12413 return 1;
12414 }
12415
12416 static enum print_stop_action
12417 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12418 {
12419 struct breakpoint *b;
12420 const struct bp_location *bl;
12421 int bp_temp;
12422 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12423
12424 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12425
12426 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12427 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12428
12429 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12430 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12431 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12432 bl->address,
12433 b->number, 1);
12434 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12435 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12436
12437 if (bp_temp)
12438 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12439 else
12440 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12441 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12442 {
12443 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12444 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12445 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12446 }
12447 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12448 uiout->text (", ");
12449
12450 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12451 }
12452
12453 static void
12454 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12455 {
12456 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12457 return;
12458
12459 switch (b->type)
12460 {
12461 case bp_breakpoint:
12462 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12463 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12464 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12465 else
12466 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12467 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12468 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12469 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12470 break;
12471 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12472 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12473 break;
12474 case bp_dprintf:
12475 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12476 break;
12477 }
12478
12479 say_where (b);
12480 }
12481
12482 static void
12483 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12484 {
12485 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12486 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12487 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12488 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12489 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12490 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12491 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12492 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12493 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12494 else
12495 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12496 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12497
12498 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12499 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12500
12501 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12502 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12503 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12504 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12505
12506 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12507 }
12508
12509 static void
12510 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12511 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12512 enum bptype type_wanted)
12513 {
12514 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12515 }
12516
12517 static void
12518 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12519 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12520 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12521 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12522 enum bptype type_wanted,
12523 enum bpdisp disposition,
12524 int thread,
12525 int task, int ignore_count,
12526 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12527 int from_tty, int enabled,
12528 int internal, unsigned flags)
12529 {
12530 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12531 std::move (cond_string),
12532 std::move (extra_string),
12533 type_wanted,
12534 disposition, thread, task,
12535 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12536 enabled, internal, flags);
12537 }
12538
12539 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12540 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12541 const struct event_location *location,
12542 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12543 {
12544 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12545 }
12546
12547 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12548
12549 static void
12550 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12551 {
12552 switch (b->type)
12553 {
12554 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12555 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12556 case bp_overlay_event:
12557 case bp_longjmp_master:
12558 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12559 case bp_exception_master:
12560 delete_breakpoint (b);
12561 break;
12562
12563 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12564 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12565 case bp_shlib_event:
12566
12567 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12568 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12569 case bp_thread_event:
12570 break;
12571 }
12572 }
12573
12574 static void
12575 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12576 {
12577 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12578 {
12579 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12580 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12581 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12582 objects (among other things). */
12583 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12584 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12585 }
12586 else
12587 bs->stop = 0;
12588 }
12589
12590 static enum print_stop_action
12591 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12592 {
12593 struct breakpoint *b;
12594
12595 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12596
12597 switch (b->type)
12598 {
12599 case bp_shlib_event:
12600 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12601 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12602 to shlib event" message.) */
12603 print_solib_event (0);
12604 break;
12605
12606 case bp_thread_event:
12607 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12608 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12609 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12610 break;
12611
12612 case bp_overlay_event:
12613 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12614 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12615 break;
12616
12617 case bp_longjmp_master:
12618 /* These should never be enabled. */
12619 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12620 break;
12621
12622 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12623 /* These should never be enabled. */
12624 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12625 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12626 break;
12627
12628 case bp_exception_master:
12629 /* These should never be enabled. */
12630 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12631 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12632 break;
12633 }
12634
12635 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12636 }
12637
12638 static void
12639 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12640 {
12641 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12642 }
12643
12644 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12645
12646 static void
12647 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12648 {
12649 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12650 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12651 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12652 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12653 }
12654
12655 static void
12656 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12657 {
12658 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12659 }
12660
12661 static enum print_stop_action
12662 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12663 {
12664 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12665 }
12666
12667 static void
12668 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12669 {
12670 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12671 }
12672
12673 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12674
12675 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12676 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12677
12678 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12679 {
12680 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12681
12682 if (tp != NULL)
12683 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12684 }
12685
12686 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12687
12688 static int
12689 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12690 {
12691 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12692
12693 if (v == 0)
12694 {
12695 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12696 if needed. */
12697 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12698 }
12699
12700 return v;
12701 }
12702
12703 static int
12704 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12705 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12706 {
12707 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12708 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12709
12710 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12711 }
12712
12713 static void
12714 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12715 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12716 enum bptype type_wanted)
12717 {
12718 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12719
12720 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12721 lsal.canonical
12722 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12723 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12724 }
12725
12726 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12727 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12728 const struct event_location *location,
12729 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12730 {
12731 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12732 if (sals.empty ())
12733 error (_("probe not found"));
12734 return sals;
12735 }
12736
12737 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12738
12739 static void
12740 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12741 {
12742 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12743 }
12744
12745 static int
12746 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12747 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12748 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12749 {
12750 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12751 tracepoints. */
12752 return 0;
12753 }
12754
12755 static void
12756 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12757 struct ui_out *uiout)
12758 {
12759 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12760 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12761 {
12762 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12763
12764 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12765 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12766 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12767 uiout->text ("\n");
12768 }
12769 }
12770
12771 static void
12772 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12773 {
12774 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12775 return;
12776
12777 switch (b->type)
12778 {
12779 case bp_tracepoint:
12780 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12781 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12782 break;
12783 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12784 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12785 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12786 break;
12787 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12788 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12789 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12790 break;
12791 default:
12792 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12793 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12794 }
12795
12796 say_where (b);
12797 }
12798
12799 static void
12800 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12801 {
12802 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12803
12804 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12805 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12806 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12807 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12808 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12809 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12810 else
12811 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12812 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12813
12814 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12815 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12816 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12817
12818 if (tp->pass_count)
12819 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12820 }
12821
12822 static void
12823 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12824 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12825 enum bptype type_wanted)
12826 {
12827 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12828 }
12829
12830 static void
12831 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12832 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12833 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12834 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12835 enum bptype type_wanted,
12836 enum bpdisp disposition,
12837 int thread,
12838 int task, int ignore_count,
12839 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12840 int from_tty, int enabled,
12841 int internal, unsigned flags)
12842 {
12843 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12844 std::move (cond_string),
12845 std::move (extra_string),
12846 type_wanted,
12847 disposition, thread, task,
12848 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12849 enabled, internal, flags);
12850 }
12851
12852 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12853 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12854 const struct event_location *location,
12855 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12856 {
12857 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12858 }
12859
12860 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12861
12862 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
12863 static probe. */
12864
12865 static void
12866 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12867 (const struct event_location *location,
12868 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12869 enum bptype type_wanted)
12870 {
12871 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12872 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12873 }
12874
12875 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12876 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12877 const struct event_location *location,
12878 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12879 {
12880 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12881 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12882 }
12883
12884 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
12885
12886 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12887
12888 static void
12889 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12890 {
12891 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12892
12893 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12894 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12895
12896 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12897 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12898 3 - disconnect from target 1
12899 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12900
12901 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12902 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12903 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12904 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12905 it all the time. */
12906 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12907 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12908 }
12909
12910 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12911
12912 static void
12913 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12914 {
12915 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
12916 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
12917 tp->extra_string);
12918 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12919 }
12920
12921 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
12922 dprintf.
12923
12924 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
12925 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
12926 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
12927 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
12928 address are all handled. */
12929
12930 static void
12931 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12932 {
12933 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
12934 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
12935
12936 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
12937 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
12938 condition not be evaluated. */
12939 bs->stop = 0;
12940
12941 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
12942 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
12943 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
12944 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
12945 commands here throws. */
12946 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
12947 bs->commands = NULL;
12948
12949 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
12950
12951 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
12952 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
12953 list. */
12954 }
12955
12956 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
12957 markers (`-m'). */
12958
12959 static void
12960 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12961 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12962 enum bptype type_wanted)
12963 {
12964 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12965 const char *arg_start, *arg;
12966
12967 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
12968 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
12969
12970 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
12971 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
12972 canonical->location
12973 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
12974
12975 lsal.canonical
12976 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12977 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12978 }
12979
12980 static void
12981 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12982 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12983 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12984 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12985 enum bptype type_wanted,
12986 enum bpdisp disposition,
12987 int thread,
12988 int task, int ignore_count,
12989 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12990 int from_tty, int enabled,
12991 int internal, unsigned flags)
12992 {
12993 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
12994
12995 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
12996 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
12997 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
12998 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
12999 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13000 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13001
13002 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13003 {
13004 event_location_up location
13005 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13006
13007 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13008 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13009 std::move (location), NULL,
13010 std::move (cond_string),
13011 std::move (extra_string),
13012 type_wanted, disposition,
13013 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13014 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13015 canonical->special_display);
13016 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13017 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13018 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13019 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13020 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13021 corresponds to this one */
13022 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13023
13024 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13025 }
13026 }
13027
13028 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13029 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13030 const struct event_location *location,
13031 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13032 {
13033 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13034 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13035
13036 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13037 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13038 {
13039 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13040 sals.resize (1);
13041 return sals;
13042 }
13043 else
13044 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13045 }
13046
13047 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13048
13049 static int
13050 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13051 {
13052 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13053 }
13054
13055 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13056 structures. */
13057
13058 void
13059 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13060 {
13061 struct breakpoint *b;
13062
13063 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13064
13065 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13066 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13067 especial culprits.
13068
13069 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13070 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13071 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13072 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13073 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13074 deleted.
13075
13076 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13077 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13078 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13079 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13080 was chosen. */
13081 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13082 return;
13083
13084 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13085 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13086 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13087 {
13088 struct breakpoint *related;
13089 struct watchpoint *w;
13090
13091 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13092 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13093 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13094 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13095 else
13096 w = NULL;
13097 if (w != NULL)
13098 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13099
13100 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13101 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13102 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13103 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13104 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13105 }
13106
13107 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13108 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13109 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13110 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13111 if (bpt->number)
13112 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13113
13114 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13115 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13116
13117 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13118 if (b->next == bpt)
13119 {
13120 b->next = bpt->next;
13121 break;
13122 }
13123
13124 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13125 been freed. */
13126 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13127 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13128 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13129 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13130 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13131 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13132 commands won't work. */
13133
13134 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13135
13136 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13137 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13138 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13139 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13140 might be better design to have location completely
13141 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13142 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13143
13144 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13145 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13146 bpt->type = bp_none;
13147 delete bpt;
13148 }
13149
13150 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13151 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13152
13153 static void
13154 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13155 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13156 {
13157 struct breakpoint *related;
13158
13159 related = b;
13160 do
13161 {
13162 struct breakpoint *next;
13163
13164 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13165 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13166
13167 if (next == related)
13168 {
13169 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13170 function (related);
13171
13172 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13173 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13174 out. */
13175 break;
13176 }
13177 else
13178 function (related);
13179
13180 related = next;
13181 }
13182 while (related != b);
13183 }
13184
13185 static void
13186 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13187 {
13188 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13189
13190 dont_repeat ();
13191
13192 if (arg == 0)
13193 {
13194 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13195
13196 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13197 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13198 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13199 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13200 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13201 {
13202 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13203 break;
13204 }
13205
13206 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13207 if (!from_tty
13208 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13209 {
13210 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13211 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13212 delete_breakpoint (b);
13213 }
13214 }
13215 else
13216 map_breakpoint_numbers
13217 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13218 {
13219 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13220 });
13221 }
13222
13223 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13224 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13225 considered. */
13226
13227 static int
13228 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13229 {
13230 struct bp_location *loc;
13231
13232 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13233 if ((pspace == NULL
13234 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13235 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13236 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13237 return 0;
13238 return 1;
13239 }
13240
13241 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13242 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13243 Null names are ignored. */
13244
13245 static int
13246 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13247 {
13248 struct bp_location *l;
13249 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13250 xcalloc, xfree);
13251
13252 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13253 {
13254 const char **slot;
13255 const char *name = l->function_name;
13256
13257 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13258 if (name == NULL)
13259 continue;
13260
13261 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13262 INSERT);
13263 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13264 returns NULL. */
13265 if (*slot != NULL)
13266 {
13267 htab_delete (htab);
13268 return 1;
13269 }
13270 *slot = name;
13271 }
13272
13273 htab_delete (htab);
13274 return 0;
13275 }
13276
13277 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13278 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13279 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13280 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13281 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13282 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13283 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13284 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13285 The heuristic is:
13286
13287 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13288 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13289 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13290 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13291 in the sources, and output a warning.
13292
13293 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13294 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13295 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13296 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13297 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13298 warning.
13299
13300 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13301 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13302 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13303 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13304 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13305 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13306 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13307 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13308 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13309
13310 static struct symtab_and_line
13311 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13312 {
13313 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13314 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13315 CORE_ADDR pc;
13316
13317 pc = sal.pc;
13318 if (sal.line)
13319 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13320
13321 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13322 {
13323 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13324 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13325 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13326 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13327
13328 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13329
13330 return sal;
13331 }
13332
13333 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13334 by string ID. */
13335 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13336 && sal.line != 0
13337 && sal.symtab != NULL
13338 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13339 {
13340 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13341 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13342 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13343
13344 if (!markers.empty ())
13345 {
13346 struct symbol *sym;
13347 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13348 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13349 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13350
13351 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13352
13353 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13354
13355 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13356 "found at previous line number"),
13357 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13358
13359 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13360 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13361 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13362 if (sym)
13363 {
13364 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym),
13365 ui_out_style_kind::FUNCTION);
13366 uiout->text (" at ");
13367 }
13368 uiout->field_string ("file",
13369 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
13370 ui_out_style_kind::FILE);
13371 uiout->text (":");
13372
13373 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13374 {
13375 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13376
13377 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13378 }
13379
13380 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13381 uiout->text ("\n");
13382
13383 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13384 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13385
13386 b->location.reset (NULL);
13387 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13388 explicit_loc.source_filename
13389 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13390 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13391 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13392 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13393
13394 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13395 so. */
13396 }
13397 }
13398 return sal;
13399 }
13400
13401 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13402 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13403
13404 static int
13405 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13406 {
13407 while (a && b)
13408 {
13409 if (a->address != b->address)
13410 return 0;
13411
13412 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13413 return 0;
13414
13415 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13416 return 0;
13417
13418 a = a->next;
13419 b = b->next;
13420 }
13421
13422 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13423 return 0;
13424
13425 return 1;
13426 }
13427
13428 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13429 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13430 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13431
13432 static struct bp_location *
13433 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13434 {
13435 struct bp_location head;
13436 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13437 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13438 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13439
13440 if (pspace == NULL)
13441 {
13442 i = b->loc;
13443 b->loc = NULL;
13444 return i;
13445 }
13446
13447 head.next = NULL;
13448
13449 while (i != NULL)
13450 {
13451 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13452 {
13453 *i_link = i->next;
13454 i->next = NULL;
13455 hoisted->next = i;
13456 hoisted = i;
13457 }
13458 else
13459 i_link = &i->next;
13460 i = *i_link;
13461 }
13462
13463 return head.next;
13464 }
13465
13466 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13467 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13468 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13469 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13470 untouched. */
13471
13472 void
13473 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13474 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13475 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13476 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13477 {
13478 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13479
13480 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13481 {
13482 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13483 location. */
13484 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13485 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13486 "multiple locations found\n"),
13487 b->number);
13488 return;
13489 }
13490
13491 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13492 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13493 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13494 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13495 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13496 individual locations. */
13497 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13498 return;
13499
13500 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13501
13502 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13503 {
13504 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13505
13506 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13507
13508 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13509
13510 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13511 old symtab. */
13512 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13513 {
13514 const char *s;
13515
13516 s = b->cond_string;
13517 try
13518 {
13519 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13520 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13521 0);
13522 }
13523 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
13524 {
13525 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13526 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13527 b->number, e.what ());
13528 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13529 }
13530 }
13531
13532 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13533 {
13534 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13535
13536 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13537 }
13538 }
13539
13540 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13541 breakpoints. */
13542 {
13543 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13544 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13545 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13546 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13547 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13548 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13549 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13550
13551 for (; e; e = e->next)
13552 {
13553 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13554 {
13555 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13556 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13557 {
13558 for (; l; l = l->next)
13559 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13560 {
13561 l->enabled = 0;
13562 break;
13563 }
13564 }
13565 else
13566 {
13567 for (; l; l = l->next)
13568 if (l->function_name
13569 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13570 {
13571 l->enabled = 0;
13572 break;
13573 }
13574 }
13575 }
13576 }
13577 }
13578
13579 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13580 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13581 }
13582
13583 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13584 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13585
13586 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13587 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13588 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13589 {
13590 struct gdb_exception exception;
13591
13592 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13593
13594 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13595
13596 try
13597 {
13598 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13599 }
13600 catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
13601 {
13602 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13603
13604 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13605 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13606 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13607 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13608 state, then user already saw the message about that
13609 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13610 errors. */
13611 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13612 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13613 || (b->loc != NULL
13614 && search_pspace != NULL
13615 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13616 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13617 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13618 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13619 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13620
13621 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13622 {
13623 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13624 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13625 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13626 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13627 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13628 which approach is better. */
13629 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13630 throw;
13631 }
13632
13633 exception = std::move (e);
13634 }
13635
13636 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13637 {
13638 for (auto &sal : sals)
13639 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13640 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13641 {
13642 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13643 int thread, task;
13644
13645 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13646 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13647 &extra_string);
13648 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13649 if (cond_string)
13650 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13651 b->thread = thread;
13652 b->task = task;
13653 if (extra_string)
13654 {
13655 xfree (b->extra_string);
13656 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13657 }
13658 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13659 }
13660
13661 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13662 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13663
13664 *found = 1;
13665 }
13666 else
13667 *found = 0;
13668
13669 return sals;
13670 }
13671
13672 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13673 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13674 locations. */
13675
13676 static void
13677 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13678 {
13679 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13680 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13681
13682 int found;
13683 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13684 filter_pspace, &found);
13685 if (found)
13686 expanded = std::move (sals);
13687
13688 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13689 {
13690 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13691 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13692 filter_pspace, &found);
13693 if (found)
13694 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13695 }
13696
13697 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13698 }
13699
13700 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13701 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13702
13703 static void
13704 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13705 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13706 enum bptype type_wanted)
13707 {
13708 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13709 }
13710
13711 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13712 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13713 breakpoint_ops. */
13714
13715 static void
13716 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13717 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13718 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13719 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13720 enum bptype type_wanted,
13721 enum bpdisp disposition,
13722 int thread,
13723 int task, int ignore_count,
13724 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13725 int from_tty, int enabled,
13726 int internal, unsigned flags)
13727 {
13728 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13729 std::move (cond_string),
13730 std::move (extra_string),
13731 type_wanted, disposition,
13732 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13733 enabled, internal, flags);
13734 }
13735
13736 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13737 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13738
13739 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13740 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13741 const struct event_location *location,
13742 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13743 {
13744 struct linespec_result canonical;
13745
13746 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13747 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13748 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13749 b->filter);
13750
13751 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13752 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13753
13754 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13755 {
13756 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13757 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13758 }
13759 return {};
13760 }
13761
13762 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13763
13764 static void
13765 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13766 {
13767 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13768 set_language (b->language);
13769
13770 b->ops->re_set (b);
13771 }
13772
13773 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13774 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13775
13776 void
13777 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13778 {
13779 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13780
13781 {
13782 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13783 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13784 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13785
13786 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13787 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13788 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13789 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13790 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13791 we select the current frame.
13792
13793 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13794 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13795 have been reset. */
13796 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13797 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13798
13799 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13800 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13801 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13802 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13803
13804 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13805 {
13806 try
13807 {
13808 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13809 }
13810 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
13811 {
13812 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13813 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13814 b->number);
13815 }
13816 }
13817
13818 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13819 }
13820
13821 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13822 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13823 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13824 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13825
13826 /* Now we can insert. */
13827 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13828 }
13829 \f
13830 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13831
13832 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13833 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13834 void
13835 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13836 {
13837 if (b->thread != -1)
13838 {
13839 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13840
13841 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13842 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13843 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13844 as well. */
13845 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13846 }
13847 }
13848
13849 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13850 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13851 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13852
13853 void
13854 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13855 {
13856 struct breakpoint *b;
13857
13858 if (count < 0)
13859 count = 0;
13860
13861 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13862 if (b->number == bptnum)
13863 {
13864 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13865 {
13866 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13867 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13868 bptnum);
13869 return;
13870 }
13871
13872 b->ignore_count = count;
13873 if (from_tty)
13874 {
13875 if (count == 0)
13876 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13877 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13878 bptnum);
13879 else if (count == 1)
13880 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13881 bptnum);
13882 else
13883 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13884 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13885 count, bptnum);
13886 }
13887 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13888 return;
13889 }
13890
13891 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13892 }
13893
13894 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13895
13896 static void
13897 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13898 {
13899 const char *p = args;
13900 int num;
13901
13902 if (p == 0)
13903 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13904
13905 num = get_number (&p);
13906 if (num == 0)
13907 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13908 if (*p == 0)
13909 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13910
13911 set_ignore_count (num,
13912 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
13913 from_tty);
13914 if (from_tty)
13915 printf_filtered ("\n");
13916 }
13917 \f
13918
13919 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
13920 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
13921
13922 static void
13923 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
13924 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13925 {
13926 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
13927 {
13928 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
13929 bp_num_range.first);
13930 }
13931 else
13932 {
13933 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
13934
13935 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
13936 {
13937 bool match = false;
13938
13939 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
13940 if (b->number == i)
13941 {
13942 match = true;
13943 function (b);
13944 break;
13945 }
13946 if (!match)
13947 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
13948 }
13949 }
13950 }
13951
13952 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
13953 ARGS. */
13954
13955 static void
13956 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
13957 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13958 {
13959 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
13960 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
13961
13962 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
13963
13964 while (!parser.finished ())
13965 {
13966 int num = parser.get_number ();
13967 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
13968 }
13969 }
13970
13971 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
13972 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
13973
13974 static struct bp_location *
13975 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
13976 {
13977 struct breakpoint *b;
13978
13979 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13980 if (b->number == bp_num)
13981 {
13982 break;
13983 }
13984
13985 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
13986 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
13987
13988 if (loc_num == 0)
13989 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13990
13991 int n = 0;
13992 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13993 if (++n == loc_num)
13994 return loc;
13995
13996 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
13997 }
13998
13999 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14000 enum class extract_bp_kind
14001 {
14002 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14003 bp,
14004
14005 /* Extracting a location number. */
14006 loc,
14007 };
14008
14009 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14010 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14011 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14012 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14013 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14014
14015 static int
14016 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14017 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14018 {
14019 const char *end = start;
14020 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14021 if (num < 0)
14022 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14023 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14024 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14025 int (end - start), start);
14026 if (num == 0)
14027 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14028 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14029 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14030 int (end - start), start);
14031
14032 if (end_out != NULL)
14033 *end_out = end;
14034 return num;
14035 }
14036
14037 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14038 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14039 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14040 are always positive integers. */
14041
14042 static std::pair<int, int>
14043 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14044 const std::string &arg,
14045 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14046 {
14047 std::pair<int, int> range;
14048 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14049 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14050 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14051 {
14052 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14053 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14054 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14055 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14056 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14057 bp_loc);
14058
14059 const char *end;
14060 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14061 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14062 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14063 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14064
14065 if (range.first > range.second)
14066 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14067 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14068 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14069 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14070 }
14071 else
14072 {
14073 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14074 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14075 range.second = range.first;
14076 }
14077 return range;
14078 }
14079
14080 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14081 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14082 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14083
14084 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14085
14086 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14087 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14088 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14089 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14090 location number range.
14091 */
14092
14093 static void
14094 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14095 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14096 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14097 {
14098 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14099
14100 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14101 {
14102 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14103
14104 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14105 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14106
14107 bp_num_range.first
14108 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14109 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14110
14111 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14112 arg, dot + 1);
14113 }
14114 else
14115 {
14116 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14117
14118 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14119 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14120 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14121 }
14122 }
14123
14124 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14125 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14126
14127 static void
14128 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14129 {
14130 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14131 if (loc != NULL)
14132 {
14133 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14134 {
14135 loc->enabled = enable;
14136 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14137 }
14138 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14139 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14140 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14141 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14142 }
14143 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14144
14145 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14146 }
14147
14148 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14149 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14150 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14151 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14152 location. */
14153
14154 static void
14155 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14156 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14157 bool enable)
14158 {
14159 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14160 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14161 }
14162
14163 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14164 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14165 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14166
14167 void
14168 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14169 {
14170 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14171 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14172 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14173 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14174 return;
14175
14176 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14177
14178 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14179 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14180
14181 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14182 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14183 {
14184 struct bp_location *location;
14185
14186 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14187 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14188 }
14189
14190 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14191
14192 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14193 }
14194
14195 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14196 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14197 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14198 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14199
14200 static void
14201 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14202 {
14203 if (args == 0)
14204 {
14205 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14206
14207 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14208 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14209 {
14210 if (enable)
14211 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14212 else
14213 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14214 }
14215 }
14216 else
14217 {
14218 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14219
14220 while (!num.empty ())
14221 {
14222 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14223
14224 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14225
14226 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14227 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14228 {
14229 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14230 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14231 enable
14232 ? enable_breakpoint
14233 : disable_breakpoint);
14234 }
14235 else
14236 {
14237 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14238 'x.y-z'. */
14239 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14240 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14241 }
14242 num = extract_arg (&args);
14243 }
14244 }
14245 }
14246
14247 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14248 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14249 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14250 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14251
14252 static void
14253 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14254 {
14255 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14256 }
14257
14258 static void
14259 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14260 int count)
14261 {
14262 int target_resources_ok;
14263
14264 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14265 {
14266 int i;
14267 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14268 target_resources_ok =
14269 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14270 i + 1, 0);
14271 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14272 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14273 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14274 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14275 }
14276
14277 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14278 {
14279 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14280 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14281
14282 try
14283 {
14284 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14285
14286 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14287 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14288 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14289 }
14290 catch (const gdb_exception &e)
14291 {
14292 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14293 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14294 bpt->number);
14295 return;
14296 }
14297 }
14298
14299 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14300
14301 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14302 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14303
14304 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14305 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14306 {
14307 struct bp_location *location;
14308
14309 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14310 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14311 }
14312
14313 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14314 bpt->enable_count = count;
14315 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14316
14317 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14318 }
14319
14320
14321 void
14322 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14323 {
14324 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14325 }
14326
14327 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14328 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14329 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14330 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14331
14332 static void
14333 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14334 {
14335 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14336 }
14337
14338 static void
14339 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14340 {
14341 map_breakpoint_numbers
14342 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14343 {
14344 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14345 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14346 {
14347 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14348 });
14349 });
14350 }
14351
14352 static void
14353 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14354 {
14355 int count;
14356
14357 if (args == NULL)
14358 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14359
14360 count = get_number (&args);
14361
14362 map_breakpoint_numbers
14363 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14364 {
14365 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14366 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14367 {
14368 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14369 });
14370 });
14371 }
14372
14373 static void
14374 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14375 {
14376 map_breakpoint_numbers
14377 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14378 {
14379 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14380 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14381 {
14382 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14383 });
14384 });
14385 }
14386 \f
14387 static void
14388 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14389 {
14390 }
14391
14392 static void
14393 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14394 {
14395 }
14396
14397 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14398 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14399 GDB itself. */
14400
14401 static void
14402 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14403 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14404 const bfd_byte *data)
14405 {
14406 struct breakpoint *bp;
14407
14408 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14409 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14410 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14411 {
14412 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14413
14414 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14415 {
14416 struct bp_location *loc;
14417
14418 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14419 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14420 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14421 && addr + len > loc->address)
14422 {
14423 wp->val = NULL;
14424 wp->val_valid = 0;
14425 }
14426 }
14427 }
14428 }
14429
14430 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14431
14432 void
14433 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14434 const address_space *aspace,
14435 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14436 {
14437 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14438 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14439 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14440
14441 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14442 {
14443 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14444 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14445 }
14446
14447 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14448 sal.pc = pc;
14449 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14450 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14451 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14452
14453 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14454 }
14455
14456 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14457
14458 int
14459 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14460 {
14461 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14462 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14463
14464 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14465
14466 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14467 {
14468 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14469 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14470
14471 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14472 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14473
14474 return 1;
14475 }
14476 else
14477 return 0;
14478 }
14479
14480 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14481
14482 int
14483 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14484 const address_space *aspace,
14485 CORE_ADDR pc)
14486 {
14487 struct bp_location *loc;
14488
14489 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14490 if (loc->inserted
14491 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14492 return 1;
14493
14494 return 0;
14495 }
14496
14497 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14498 PC. */
14499
14500 int
14501 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14502 CORE_ADDR pc)
14503 {
14504 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14505
14506 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14507 {
14508 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14509 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14510 return 1;
14511 }
14512 return 0;
14513 }
14514
14515 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14516
14517 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14518 static void
14519 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14520 {
14521 tracepoint_count = num;
14522 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14523 }
14524
14525 static void
14526 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14527 {
14528 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14529
14530 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14531 current_language);
14532 if (location != NULL
14533 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14534 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14535 else
14536 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14537
14538 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14539 location.get (),
14540 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14541 0 /* tempflag */,
14542 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14543 0 /* Ignore count */,
14544 pending_break_support,
14545 ops,
14546 from_tty,
14547 1 /* enabled */,
14548 0 /* internal */, 0);
14549 }
14550
14551 static void
14552 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14553 {
14554 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14555 current_language);
14556 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14557 location.get (),
14558 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14559 0 /* tempflag */,
14560 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14561 0 /* Ignore count */,
14562 pending_break_support,
14563 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14564 from_tty,
14565 1 /* enabled */,
14566 0 /* internal */, 0);
14567 }
14568
14569 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14570
14571 static void
14572 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14573 {
14574 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14575 event_location_up location;
14576
14577 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14578 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14579 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14580 {
14581 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14582 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14583 }
14584 else
14585 {
14586 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14587 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14588 }
14589
14590 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14591 location.get (),
14592 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14593 0 /* tempflag */,
14594 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14595 0 /* Ignore count */,
14596 pending_break_support,
14597 ops,
14598 from_tty,
14599 1 /* enabled */,
14600 0 /* internal */, 0);
14601 }
14602
14603 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14604 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14605
14606 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14607 static int next_cmd;
14608
14609 static char *
14610 read_uploaded_action (void)
14611 {
14612 char *rslt = nullptr;
14613
14614 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14615 {
14616 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14617 next_cmd++;
14618 }
14619
14620 return rslt;
14621 }
14622
14623 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14624 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14625 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14626 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14627 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14628
14629 struct tracepoint *
14630 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14631 {
14632 const char *addr_str;
14633 char small_buf[100];
14634 struct tracepoint *tp;
14635
14636 if (utp->at_string)
14637 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14638 else
14639 {
14640 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14641 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14642 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14643 user. */
14644 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14645 "source location, using raw address"),
14646 utp->number);
14647 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14648 addr_str = small_buf;
14649 }
14650
14651 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14652 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14653 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14654 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14655 utp->number);
14656
14657 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14658 current_language);
14659 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14660 location.get (),
14661 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14662 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14663 0 /* tempflag */,
14664 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14665 0 /* Ignore count */,
14666 pending_break_support,
14667 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14668 0 /* from_tty */,
14669 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14670 0 /* internal */,
14671 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14672 return NULL;
14673
14674 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14675 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14676 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14677
14678 if (utp->pass > 0)
14679 {
14680 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14681 tp->number);
14682
14683 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14684 }
14685
14686 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14687 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14688 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14689 function. */
14690 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14691 {
14692 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14693
14694 this_utp = utp;
14695 next_cmd = 0;
14696
14697 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14698
14699 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14700 }
14701 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14702 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14703 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14704 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14705 utp->number);
14706
14707 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14708 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14709 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14710
14711 return tp;
14712 }
14713
14714 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14715 omitted. */
14716
14717 static void
14718 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14719 {
14720 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14721 int num_printed;
14722
14723 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14724
14725 if (num_printed == 0)
14726 {
14727 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14728 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14729 else
14730 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14731 }
14732
14733 default_collect_info ();
14734 }
14735
14736 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14737 Not supported by all targets. */
14738 static void
14739 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14740 {
14741 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14742 }
14743
14744 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14745 Not supported by all targets. */
14746 static void
14747 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14748 {
14749 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14750 }
14751
14752 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14753 static void
14754 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14755 {
14756 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14757
14758 dont_repeat ();
14759
14760 if (arg == 0)
14761 {
14762 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14763
14764 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14765 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14766 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14767 argument. */
14768 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14769 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14770 {
14771 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14772 break;
14773 }
14774
14775 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14776 if (!from_tty
14777 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14778 {
14779 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14780 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14781 delete_breakpoint (b);
14782 }
14783 }
14784 else
14785 map_breakpoint_numbers
14786 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14787 {
14788 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14789 });
14790 }
14791
14792 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14793
14794 static void
14795 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14796 {
14797 tp->pass_count = count;
14798 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14799 if (from_tty)
14800 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14801 tp->number, count);
14802 }
14803
14804 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14805
14806 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14807 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14808 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14809
14810 static void
14811 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14812 {
14813 struct tracepoint *t1;
14814 ULONGEST count;
14815
14816 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14817 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14818 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14819
14820 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14821
14822 args = skip_spaces (args);
14823 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14824 {
14825 struct breakpoint *b;
14826
14827 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14828 if (*args)
14829 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14830
14831 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14832 {
14833 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14834 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14835 }
14836 }
14837 else if (*args == '\0')
14838 {
14839 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14840 if (t1)
14841 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14842 }
14843 else
14844 {
14845 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14846 while (!parser.finished ())
14847 {
14848 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14849 if (t1)
14850 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14851 }
14852 }
14853 }
14854
14855 struct tracepoint *
14856 get_tracepoint (int num)
14857 {
14858 struct breakpoint *t;
14859
14860 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14861 if (t->number == num)
14862 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14863
14864 return NULL;
14865 }
14866
14867 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14868 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14869 reconnecting). */
14870
14871 struct tracepoint *
14872 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14873 {
14874 struct breakpoint *b;
14875
14876 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14877 {
14878 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14879
14880 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14881 return t;
14882 }
14883
14884 return NULL;
14885 }
14886
14887 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14888 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14889 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14890 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14891
14892 struct tracepoint *
14893 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14894 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14895 {
14896 struct breakpoint *t;
14897 int tpnum;
14898 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14899
14900 if (parser != NULL)
14901 {
14902 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14903 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14904 }
14905 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14906 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14907 else
14908 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14909
14910 if (tpnum <= 0)
14911 {
14912 if (instring && *instring)
14913 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14914 instring);
14915 else
14916 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14917 return NULL;
14918 }
14919
14920 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14921 if (t->number == tpnum)
14922 {
14923 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14924 }
14925
14926 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14927 return NULL;
14928 }
14929
14930 void
14931 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14932 {
14933 if (b->thread != -1)
14934 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14935
14936 if (b->task != 0)
14937 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
14938
14939 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
14940 }
14941
14942 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14943 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14944 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14945 non-zero. */
14946
14947 static void
14948 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
14949 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
14950 {
14951 struct breakpoint *tp;
14952 int any = 0;
14953 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
14954
14955 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
14956 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
14957
14958 /* See if we have anything to save. */
14959 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
14960 {
14961 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
14962 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14963 continue;
14964
14965 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
14966 if (filter && !filter (tp))
14967 continue;
14968
14969 any = 1;
14970
14971 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
14972 {
14973 extra_trace_bits = 1;
14974
14975 /* We can stop searching. */
14976 break;
14977 }
14978 }
14979
14980 if (!any)
14981 {
14982 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
14983 return;
14984 }
14985
14986 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
14987
14988 stdio_file fp;
14989
14990 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
14991 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
14992 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
14993
14994 if (extra_trace_bits)
14995 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
14996
14997 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
14998 {
14999 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15000 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15001 continue;
15002
15003 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15004 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15005 continue;
15006
15007 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15008
15009 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15010 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15011 instead. */
15012
15013 if (tp->cond_string)
15014 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15015
15016 if (tp->ignore_count)
15017 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15018
15019 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15020 {
15021 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15022
15023 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15024 try
15025 {
15026 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15027 }
15028 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
15029 {
15030 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15031 throw;
15032 }
15033
15034 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15035 fp.puts (" end\n");
15036 }
15037
15038 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15039 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15040
15041 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15042 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15043 special, and not user visible. */
15044 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15045 {
15046 struct bp_location *loc;
15047 int n = 1;
15048
15049 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15050 if (!loc->enabled)
15051 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15052 }
15053 }
15054
15055 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15056 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15057
15058 if (from_tty)
15059 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15060 }
15061
15062 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15063
15064 static void
15065 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15066 {
15067 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15068 }
15069
15070 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15071
15072 static void
15073 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15074 {
15075 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15076 }
15077
15078 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15079
15080 std::vector<breakpoint *>
15081 all_tracepoints (void)
15082 {
15083 std::vector<breakpoint *> tp_vec;
15084 struct breakpoint *tp;
15085
15086 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15087 {
15088 tp_vec.push_back (tp);
15089 }
15090
15091 return tp_vec;
15092 }
15093
15094 \f
15095 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15096 locations used by several commands. */
15097
15098 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15099 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15100 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15101 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15102 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15103 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15104 \n\
15105 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15106 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15107 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15108 \n\
15109 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15110 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15111 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15112 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15113 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15114 \n\
15115 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15116 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15117 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15118 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15119 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15120 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15121
15122 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15123 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15124 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15125 command. */
15126
15127 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15128 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15129 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15130 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15131 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15132 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15133 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15134 below.\n\
15135 \n\
15136 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15137 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15138 \n\
15139 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15140 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15141 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15142 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15143 conditions are different.\n\
15144 \n\
15145 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15146
15147 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15148 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15149
15150 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15151 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15152
15153 void
15154 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15155 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15156 completer_ftype *completer,
15157 void *user_data_catch,
15158 void *user_data_tcatch)
15159 {
15160 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15161
15162 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15163 &catch_cmdlist);
15164 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15165 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15166 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15167
15168 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15169 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15170 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15171 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15172 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15173 }
15174
15175 static void
15176 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15177 {
15178 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15179 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15180 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15181 }
15182
15183 struct breakpoint *
15184 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15185 void *data)
15186 {
15187 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15188
15189 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15190 {
15191 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15192 return b;
15193 }
15194
15195 return NULL;
15196 }
15197
15198 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15199 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15200
15201 static int
15202 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15203 {
15204 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15205 non-inline function. */
15206 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15207 return 1;
15208
15209 return 0;
15210 }
15211
15212 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15213 have been inlined. */
15214
15215 int
15216 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15217 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15218 {
15219 struct breakpoint *b;
15220 struct bp_location *bl;
15221
15222 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15223 {
15224 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15225 continue;
15226
15227 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15228 {
15229 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15230 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15231 return 1;
15232 }
15233 }
15234
15235 return 0;
15236 }
15237
15238 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15239
15240 void
15241 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15242 {
15243 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15244
15245 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15246 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15247 loc->symtab = NULL;
15248 }
15249
15250 void
15251 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15252 {
15253 static int initialized = 0;
15254
15255 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15256
15257 if (initialized)
15258 return;
15259 initialized = 1;
15260
15261 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15262 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15263 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15264 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15265 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15266 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15267 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15268 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15269 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15270 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15271 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15272 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15273
15274 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15275 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15276 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15277 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15278 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15279 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15280 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15281 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15282
15283 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15284 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15285 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15286 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15287 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15288 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15289 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15290 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15291 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15292 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15293
15294 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15295 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15296 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15297 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15298 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15299 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15300 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15301
15302 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15303 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15304 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15305 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15306 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15307 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15308 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15309
15310 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15311 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15312 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15313 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15314 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15315 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15316 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15317
15318 /* Watchpoints. */
15319 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15320 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15321 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15322 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15323 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15324 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15325 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15326 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15327 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15328 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15329 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15330 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15331 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15332
15333 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15334 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15335 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15336 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15337 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15338 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15339 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15340 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15341 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15342 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15343 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15344
15345 /* Tracepoints. */
15346 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15347 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15348 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15349 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15350 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15351 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15352 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15353 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15354 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15355 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15356
15357 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15358 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15359 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15360 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15361 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15362
15363 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15364 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15365 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15366 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15367 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15368 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15369
15370 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15371 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15372 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15373 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15374 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15375 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15376 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15377 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15378 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15379 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15380
15381 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15382 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15383 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15384 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15385 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15386 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15387 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15388 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15389 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15390 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15391
15392 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15393 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15394 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15395 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15396 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15397 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15398 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15399 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15400 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15401 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15402
15403 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15404 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15405 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15406 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15407 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15408 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15409 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15410 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15411 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15412 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15413 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15414
15415 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15416 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15417 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15418 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15419 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15420 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15421 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15422 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15423 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15424 }
15425
15426 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15427
15428 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15429
15430 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15431
15432 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15433
15434 void
15435 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15436 {
15437 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15438
15439 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15440
15441 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15442 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15443 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15444
15445 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15446 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15447 before a breakpoint is set. */
15448 breakpoint_count = 0;
15449
15450 tracepoint_count = 0;
15451
15452 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15453 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15454 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15455
15456 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15457 commands_command, _("\
15458 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15459 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15460 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15461 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15462 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15463 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15464 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15465 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15466 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15467
15468 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15469 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15470 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15471 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15472 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15473
15474 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15475 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15476 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15477 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15478 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15479 \n"
15480 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15481 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15482
15483 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15484 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15485 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15486 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15487 \n"
15488 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15489 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15490
15491 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15492 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15493 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15494 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15495 \n"
15496 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15497 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15498
15499 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15500 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15501 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15502 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15503 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15504 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15505 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15506
15507 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15508
15509 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15510 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15511 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15512 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15513 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15514 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15515
15516 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15517 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15518 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15519 &enablebreaklist);
15520
15521 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15522 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15523 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15524 &enablebreaklist);
15525
15526 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15527 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15528 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15529 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15530 &enablebreaklist);
15531
15532 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15533 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15534 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15535 &enablelist);
15536
15537 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15538 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15539 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15540 &enablelist);
15541
15542 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15543 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15544 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15545 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15546 &enablelist);
15547
15548 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15549 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15550 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15551 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15552 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15553 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15554 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15555 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15556
15557 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15558 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15559 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15560 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15561 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15562 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15563 &disablelist);
15564
15565 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15566 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15567 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15568 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15569 \n\
15570 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15571 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15572 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15573 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15574 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15575
15576 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15577 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15578 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15579 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15580 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15581 &deletelist);
15582
15583 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15584 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15585 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15586 \n\
15587 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15588 is executing in.\n"
15589 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15590 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15591 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15592
15593 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15594 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15595 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15596 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15597
15598 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15599 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15600 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15601 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15602
15603 if (dbx_commands)
15604 {
15605 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15606 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15607 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15608 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15609 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15610 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15611 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15612 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15613 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15614 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15615 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15616 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15617 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15618 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15619 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15620 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15621 \n\
15622 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15623 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15624 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15625 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15626 breakpoint set."));
15627 }
15628
15629 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15630 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15631 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15632 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15633 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15634 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15635 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15636 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15637 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15638 \n\
15639 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15640 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15641 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15642 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15643 breakpoint set."));
15644
15645 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15646
15647 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15648 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15649 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15650 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15651 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15652 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15653 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15654 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15655 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15656 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15657 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15658 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15659 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15660 \n\
15661 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15662 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15663 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15664 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15665 breakpoint set."),
15666 &maintenanceinfolist);
15667
15668 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15669 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15670 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15671 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15672
15673 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15674 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15675 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15676 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15677
15678 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15679 catch_fork_command_1,
15680 NULL,
15681 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15682 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15683 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15684 catch_fork_command_1,
15685 NULL,
15686 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15687 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15688 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15689 catch_exec_command_1,
15690 NULL,
15691 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15692 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15693 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15694 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15695 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15696 catch_load_command_1,
15697 NULL,
15698 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15699 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15700 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15701 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15702 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15703 catch_unload_command_1,
15704 NULL,
15705 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15706 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15707
15708 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15709 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15710 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15711 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15712 an expression changes.\n\
15713 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15714 the memory to which it refers."));
15715 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15716
15717 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15718 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15719 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15720 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15721 an expression is read.\n\
15722 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15723 the memory to which it refers."));
15724 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15725
15726 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15727 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15728 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15729 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15730 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15731 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15732 the memory to which it refers."));
15733 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15734
15735 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15736 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15737
15738 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15739 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15740 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15741 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15742 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15743 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15744 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15745 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15746 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15747 hardware.)"),
15748 NULL,
15749 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15750 &setlist, &showlist);
15751
15752 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15753
15754 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15755
15756 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15757 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15758 \n"
15759 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15760 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15761 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15762
15763 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15764 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15765 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15766 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15767
15768 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15769 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15770 \n"
15771 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15772 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15773 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15774
15775 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15776 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15777 \n\
15778 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15779 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15780 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15781 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15782 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15783 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15784 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15785 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15786 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15787 \n\
15788 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15789 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15790 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15791 conditions are different.\n\
15792 \n\
15793 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15794 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15795 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15796
15797 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15798 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15799 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15800 last tracepoint set."));
15801
15802 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15803
15804 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15805 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15806 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15807 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15808 &deletelist);
15809 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15810
15811 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15812 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15813 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15814 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15815 &disablelist);
15816 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15817
15818 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15819 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15820 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15821 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15822 &enablelist);
15823 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15824
15825 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15826 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15827 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15828 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15829 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15830
15831 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15832 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15833 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15834 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15835
15836 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15837 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15838 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15839 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15840 session to restore them."),
15841 &save_cmdlist);
15842 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15843
15844 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15845 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15846 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15847 &save_cmdlist);
15848 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15849
15850 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15851 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15852
15853 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15854 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15855 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15856 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15857 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15858 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15859 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15860 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15861 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15862 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15863 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15864 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15865
15866 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15867 &pending_break_support, _("\
15868 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15869 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15870 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15871 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15872 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15873 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15874 NULL,
15875 show_pending_break_support,
15876 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15877 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15878
15879 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15880
15881 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15882 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15883 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15884 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15885 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15886 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15887 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15888 NULL,
15889 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15890 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15891 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15892
15893 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15894 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15895 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15896 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15897 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15898 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15899 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15900 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15901 when execution stops."),
15902 NULL,
15903 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15904 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15905 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15906
15907 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15908 condition_evaluation_enums,
15909 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15910 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15911 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15912 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15913 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15914 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15915 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15916 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15917 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15918 be set to \"gdb\""),
15919 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15920 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15921 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15922 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15923
15924 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15925 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15926 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15927 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15928 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15929 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15930 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15931 or the start of the range\n\
15932 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15933 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15934 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15935 \n\
15936 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
15937 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
15938 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
15939
15940 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
15941 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
15942 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
15943 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
15944 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
15945 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15946
15947 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
15948 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
15949 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15950 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
15951 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
15952 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
15953 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
15954 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
15955 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
15956 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
15957 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15958 &setlist, &showlist);
15959
15960 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
15961 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
15962 &dprintf_function, _("\
15963 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
15964 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
15965 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15966 &setlist, &showlist);
15967
15968 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
15969 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
15970 &dprintf_channel, _("\
15971 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
15972 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
15973 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
15974 &setlist, &showlist);
15975
15976 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
15977 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
15978 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15979 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
15980 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
15981 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
15982 NULL,
15983 NULL,
15984 &setlist, &showlist);
15985
15986 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
15987 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
15988 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
15989
15990 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
15991
15992 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
15993 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
15994 }
This page took 0.665995 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.